OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.
Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 22, 2004
Registration No. 333-                    


UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549


Form S-1

REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933


Open Solutions Inc.

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)
         
Delaware   7372   22-3173050
(State or Other Jurisdiction of
Incorporation or Organization)
  (Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
  (I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)

300 Winding Brook Drive

Glastonbury, Connecticut 06033
(860) 652-3155
(Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number,
Including Area Code, of Registrant’s Principal Executive Offices)


Louis Hernandez, Jr.

Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer
Open Solutions Inc.
300 Winding Brook Drive
Glastonbury, Connecticut 06033
(860) 652-3155
(Name, Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number,
Including Area Code, of Agent For Service)


Copies to:

     
John A. Burgess, Esq.
Daniel W. Finegold, Esq.
Hale and Dorr LLP
60 State Street
Boston, Massachusetts 02109
Telephone: (617) 526-6000
Telecopy: (617) 526-5000
  Marc D. Jaffe, Esq.
Latham & Watkins LLP
885 Third Avenue
New York, New York 10022-4802
Telephone: (212) 906-1200
Telecopy: (212) 751-4864


     Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.

     If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act, check the following box.    o

     If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.    o

     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.    o

     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.    o

     If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434, check the following box.    o


CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE

                 


Proposed Maximum Proposed Maximum Amount of
Title of Each Class of Amount to Offering Price Aggregate Offering Registration
Securities to be Registered be Registered(1) Per Unit(2) Price(2) Fee(2)

Common Stock, $.01 par value per share
  4,990,291 shares   $22.04   $109,986,014   $13,936


(1)  Includes 650,907 shares that the underwriters have the option to purchase from the Registrant to cover over-allotments, if any.
(2)  Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the amount of the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(c) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. Based on the average of the high and low sale prices reported in the consolidated reporting system of the Nasdaq National Market on April 16, 2004.

     The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this registration statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.




Table of Contents

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. Neither we nor the selling stockholders may sell these securities until the Securities and Exchange Commission declares our registration statement effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state where the offer or sale is not permitted.

Filed Pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1)
Registration No. 333 - 108293

Subject to Completion, Dated April 22, 2004

Prospectus

4,339,384 shares

(Open Solutions Logo)

Common Stock

We are offering 1,000,000 shares of common stock. The selling stockholders identified in this prospectus are offering an additional 3,339,384 shares. We will not receive any of the proceeds from the sale of shares being sold by the selling stockholders.

Our common stock is quoted on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol “OPEN.” The last reported sale price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on April 21, 2004 was $23.15 per share.

Investing in our common stock involves risks that are described in the “Risk Factors” section beginning on page 7 of this prospectus.

                 

Per Share Total
Public Offering Price
  $       $    
Underwriting Discount
  $       $    
Proceeds, before expenses, to Open Solutions
  $       $    
Proceeds, before expenses, to the selling stockholders
  $       $    

      We have granted the underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up to 650,907 additional shares from us to cover any over-allotments.

Delivery of shares will be made on or about                     , 2004.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the adequacy or accuracy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.

  Friedman Billings Ramsey
  Piper Jaffray
  Wachovia Securities

The date of this Prospectus is                     , 2004.


Table of Contents

      Our enterprise-wide suite of software and services performs a financial institution’s data processing and information management functions. Our core software manages the account, transaction, lending, operations, back office, client information and reporting functions for a commercial bank, thrift or credit union on either an in-house or outsourced basis.

(Chart)


TABLE OF CONTENTS

ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS
PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
RISK FACTORS
SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
USE OF PROCEEDS
DIVIDEND POLICY
CAPITALIZATION
DILUTION
SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
MANAGEMENT
RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
PRINCIPAL AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS
DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL TAX CONSIDERATIONS FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS OF OUR COMMON STOCK
UNDERWRITING
LEGAL MATTERS
EXPERTS
WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Ex-21.1 List of Subsidiaries
EX-23.1 Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP


Table of Contents

ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS

      You should rely only on the information contained in this document or to which we have referred you. We and the selling stockholders have not, and the underwriters have not, authorized anyone to provide you with information that is different. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. We and the selling stockholders are not, and the underwriters are not, making an offer to sell these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted. You should assume that the information appearing in this prospectus is accurate only as of the date on the front cover of this prospectus. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may have changed since that date.

i


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

      This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus, but does not contain all the information that is important to you. You should read this entire prospectus carefully, including the section entitled “Risk Factors,” our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus, before making an investment decision.

Our Business

      Open Solutions Inc. is a provider of software and services that allow financial institutions to compete and service their customers more effectively. We develop, market, license and support an enterprise-wide suite of software and services that performs a financial institution’s data processing and information management functions. In contrast to traditional legacy systems, our technologies are fully integrated, open, flexible, customer-centric and efficient, permitting financial institutions to draw on and deliver consistent information quickly. We offer core software and complementary products, which can be licensed to financial institutions separately or, when combined, form a fully-integrated suite. Our technology allows our clients to access information from disparate sources and then analyze and distribute that information for use at the point of customer contact. Our software can be operated either by the financial institution internally or on an outsourced basis in one of our outsourcing centers or through an outsourcing center hosted by one of our resellers. We believe that our products and services enable our clients to reduce their overall core processing and operational costs and allow them to meet their strategic needs more effectively.

Our Market Opportunity

      According to Thomson Financial Inc., there are approximately 19,400 commercial banks, thrifts and credit unions in the United States which have an asset base of under $20 billion. We believe that these financial institutions, which have traditionally competed on the basis of personalized service, are facing increasing challenges to improve their operating efficiencies. These challenges include the entrance of non-traditional competitors, the compression of margins on traditional products, significant channel proliferation and the convergence of financial products into a single institution. These institutions have traditionally fulfilled their information technology needs through legacy computer systems, operated either by the institution itself or through an outsourcing center. Legacy systems, which operate in large mainframe or minicomputer environments, are generally highly proprietary, inflexible and costly to operate and maintain. In addition, the costs associated with modifying core software and obtaining proprietary complementary software are generally greater over time than the costs associated with newer technology.

      We believe that financial institutions today are seeking more integrated, open, flexible, customer-centric and efficient information technology solutions that:

  •  combine high performance, scalability, reliability and security with the advantages associated with relational and highly normalized (which means data is easily accessible and not stored redundantly) technology based on industry standards,
 
  •  deliver new products and services to their customers quickly and efficiently without extensive custom development,
 
  •  integrate easily with other applications used in the enterprise without expensive middleware,
 
  •  provide quick and effective access to customer and account data in order to offer better, more customized services, monitor trends and performance and cross-sell services and products,
 
  •  allow real-time access to customer data while preserving the financial institution’s ability to batch process large transactions, and
 
  •  accommodate, in a single application, multiple delivery channels, such as ATMs, telephone banking, Internet banking and wireless banking, as well as new delivery channels as they emerge.

1


Table of Contents

      We believe that information technology systems such as ours, which are based on open, industry-standard operating environments and relational databases, meet these requirements.

Our Solution

      Our core software product is a fully-integrated, open, flexible, customer-centric solution that enables financial institutions to service their customers more efficiently and effectively. Its key attributes are its:

  •  Full Integration at the Core Level. Our core software supports all of a financial institution’s principal data processing requirements using a single relational database which allows our clients to replace their highly proprietary, inflexible and costly legacy systems with one integrated software application.
 
  •  Open Architecture. Our clients can run our software on desktop and server hardware supplied by a wide array of vendors, while the flexibility and scalability of our core applications permit our clients to incorporate complementary software applications, whether designed by us or by third parties, in a cost-effective manner. In addition, our complementary products may be used with either our core software or third-party systems.
 
  •  Flexibility. Our software allows our clients to offer new products and services to their customers and to grow without reconfiguring their information technology infrastructure. In addition, we provide our software by licensing it directly for use on-site, through our own outsourcing centers or through third-party outsourcing centers, allowing our clients the flexibility to meet their specific operational and competitive requirements in the manner most cost-effective for them.
 
  •  Customer-centric Architecture. Our core software uses a relational database organized around individual customers, allowing a financial institution to update and view customer information on a real-time basis instead of relying on periodic batch processing. Our relationship management software, which acts as a natural extension of our core software, exploits the strength of our architecture and provides our clients the ability to collect and analyze data in order to generate timely and responsive initiatives and deliver those initiatives immediately to the customer.
 
  •  Efficiency. We believe that our software reduces the overall cost of a financial institution’s information technology and allows our clients to meet their strategic goals more efficiently. Our core software is fully integrated with our complementary products, can run on hardware provided by many vendors and supports third-party products, reducing an institution’s development and implementation costs. Our open architecture and flexibility allow our clients to modify their information systems requirements quickly and easily, without incurring the significant costs associated with supporting several disparate software applications. Our single relational database allows our clients to organize their data around individual customers, use our business intelligence tools to analyze and manage that data in the most efficient manner and launch new products and services desired by their customers in a cost-effective manner.

      Our proprietary software is designed to work in conjunction with certain third-party software products, including Microsoft and Oracle relational databases.

Our Strategy

      Our objective is to be the leading supplier of software and services to financial institutions. Our strategy for achieving this objective includes:

  •  expanding our share of our historical market, which includes financial institutions which have an asset base of under $20 billion,
 
  •  expanding our sources of recurring revenue, which we generate through the provision of outsourcing and maintenance services, in order to improve the predictability of our revenue,

2


Table of Contents

  •  expanding our client base by continuing to license our core software through third-party outsourcing centers,
 
  •  providing additional products and services to our installed client base, through both the internal development of new products and services and through acquisitions,
 
  •  maintaining our technological leadership in the industry,
 
  •  extending our target markets to include larger financial institutions, international financial institutions, and clients in the payroll services, insurance and brokerage industries, and
 
  •  pursuing strategic acquisitions that complement our existing products and services and expand our client base.

Recent Developments

      On February 24, 2004, we acquired Maxxar Corporation for cash consideration of $6.5 million. This acquisition expanded our complementary product offerings to include a comprehensive suite of interactive voice information solutions and computer telephony integration products.


      Open Solutions Inc. was organized as a Delaware corporation in May 1992. Our principal executive office is located at 300 Winding Brook Drive, Glastonbury, Connecticut 06033 and our telephone number is (860) 652-3155. Our corporate web site address is http://www.opensolutions.com. We make available free of charge through our website our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q and Current Reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to these reports, as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish such material to, the SEC. We have posted on our website a copy of our code of business conduct and ethics. In addition, we intend to disclose on our website any amendments to, or waivers from, our code of business conduct and ethics that are required to be publicly disclosed pursuant to rules of the SEC and the Nasdaq National Market. Information contained on our web site is not intended to be part of this prospectus.

3


Table of Contents

THE OFFERING

 
Common stock offered by Open Solutions Inc. 1,000,000 shares
 
Common stock offered by the selling stockholders 3,339,384 shares
 
Common stock outstanding after the offering 18,084,103 shares
 
Dividend policy We currently do not anticipate paying dividends on our capital stock.
 
Use of proceeds We will receive net proceeds from the offering of approximately $21.5 million, assuming an offering price of $23.15, based on the last reported sale price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on April 21, 2004. We intend to use the proceeds from the offering for working capital and general corporate purposes, including potential acquisitions.
 
We will not receive any of the proceeds from the sale of shares of common stock by the selling stockholders.
 
Nasdaq National Market symbol “OPEN”
 
Risk factors See “Risk Factors” for a discussion of factors you should carefully consider before deciding to invest in our common stock.


      The total number of outstanding shares of common stock is based on the number of shares outstanding as of March 31, 2004, and excludes:

  •  3,248,078 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options as of March 31, 2004 at a weighted average exercise price of $8.74 per share, and
 
  •  5,249,230 additional shares of common stock reserved for issuance under the 1994 Stock Incentive Plan, 2000 Stock Incentive Plan, 2003 Stock Incentive Plan and 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

      Except as otherwise indicated, information in this prospectus assumes the underwriters have not exercised their option to purchase 650,907 shares from us to cover over-allotments.

4


Table of Contents

SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

(in thousands, except per share data)

      The following summary historical consolidated financial information and other data should be read in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary financial data set forth below as of December 31, 2003, and for the three years ended December 31, 2003, are derived from audited financial statements, which appear elsewhere in this prospectus.

      Since June 2000, we have acquired six businesses, as more fully described in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. These acquisitions have significantly affected our revenues, results of operations and financial condition. The operating results of each business acquired have been, or in the case of the acquisition of Maxxar Corporation, will be included in our financial statements from the respective dates of acquisition. The historical results presented below are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for any future period.

      The unaudited as adjusted information gives effect to events that will occur upon the closing of this offering, described in footnote 2 below.

                             
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



Statement of Operations Data:
                       
Revenues:
                       
 
Software license
  $ 9,971     $ 13,449     $ 21,391  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    17,295       30,896       42,461  
     
     
     
 
Total revenues
    27,266       44,345       63,852  
Cost of revenues:
                       
 
Software license
    1,592       3,152       5,341  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    10,084       18,430       23,540  
     
     
     
 
   
Total cost of revenues
    11,676       21,582       28,881  
Operating expenses (includes restricted stock expense and related taxes of $3,444 for the year ended December 31, 2003)
    25,929       25,773       33,471  
Income (loss) from operations
    (10,339 )     (3,010 )     1,500  
Net income (loss)
  $ (9,661 )   $ (2,897 )   $ 1,309  
Preferred stock accretion charge(1)
                (31,500 )
Net loss attributable to common stockholders
  $ (9,661 )   $ (2,897 )   $ (30,191 )
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss) per common share
                       
 
— Basic
  $ (4.71 )   $ (1.18 )   $ (7.74 )
 
— Diluted
    (4.71 )     (1.18 )     (7.74 )
Weighted average common shares outstanding used to compute net income (loss) per common share
                       
 
— Basic
    2,051       2,453       3,903  
 
— Diluted
    2,051       2,453       3,903  

5


Table of Contents

                 
December 31, 2003

Actual As Adjusted(2)


Balance Sheet Data:
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 84,953     $ 106,446  
Working capital
    73,084       94,577  
Total assets
    133,071       154,564  
Stockholders’ equity
    105,419       126,912  


(1)  The conversion formula for our Series F preferred stock provided for adjustment of the Series F preferred stock conversion price in the event that our initial public offering price was less than $27.03 per share. Holders of Series F preferred stock received shares of common stock from the initial public offering with an aggregate value of $62,600,000. The recorded value of Series F preferred stock was $31,100,000 and as a result, upon the closing of our initial public offering, we recorded an accretion charge of $31,500,000 in stockholders’ equity (deficit). This accretion charge resulted in a non-cash deduction from income attributable to holders of common stock and a deduction in related earnings per share.
 
(2)  Reflects the sale by us of 1,000,000 shares of common stock offered hereby (at an assumed offering price of $23.15, based on the last reported sale price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on April 21, 2004) and deduction of the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses payable by us.

6


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

      You should carefully consider the risks described below, together with all of the other information in this prospectus, before deciding to invest in our common stock. The risks and uncertainties described below are those that we have identified as material. Risks and uncertainties not currently identifiable by us, or that we believe are immaterial, are not included below, but may also impair our business operations. If any of the events contemplated by the following discussion of risks should occur, our business, financial condition and results of operations may suffer. As a result, the trading price of our common stock could decline and you could lose part or all of your investment in our common stock.

Risks Relating to our Business

We are dependent on the banking and credit union industry, and changes within that industry could reduce demand for our products and services.

      The large majority of our revenues are derived from financial institutions in the banking and credit union industry, primarily small to mid-size banks and thrifts and credit unions of all sizes, and we expect to continue to derive substantially all of our revenues from these institutions for the foreseeable future. Unfavorable economic conditions adversely impacting the banking and credit union industry could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. For example, financial institutions in the banking and credit union industry have experienced, and may continue to experience, cyclical fluctuations in profitability as well as increasing challenges to improve their operating efficiencies. Due to the entrance of non-traditional competitors and the current environment of low interest rates, the profit margins of commercial banks, thrifts and credit unions have narrowed. As a result, some banks have slowed, and may continue to slow, their capital spending, including spending on computer software and hardware, which can negatively impact license sales of our core and complementary products to new and existing clients. Decreases in or reallocation of capital expenditures by our current and potential clients, unfavorable economic conditions and new or persisting competitive pressures could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Consolidation in the banking and financial services industry could adversely impact our business by eliminating a number of our existing and potential clients.

      There has been and continues to be merger, acquisition and consolidation activity in the banking and financial services industry. Mergers or consolidations of banks and financial institutions in the future could reduce the number of our clients and potential clients. A smaller market for our services could have a material adverse impact on our business and results of operations. In addition, it is possible that the larger banks or financial institutions which result from mergers or consolidations could decide to perform themselves some or all of the services which we currently provide or could provide. If that were to occur, it could have a material adverse impact on our business and results of operations.

Our success depends on decisions by potential clients to replace their legacy computer systems, and their failure to do so would adversely affect demand for our products and services.

      We primarily derive our revenues from two sources: license fees for software products and fees for a full range of services complementing our products, including outsourcing, installation, training, maintenance and support services. A large portion of these fees are either directly attributable to licenses of our core software system or are generated over time by clients using our core software. Banks and credit unions historically have been slow to adapt to and accept new technologies. Many of these financial institutions have traditionally met their information technology needs through legacy computer systems, in which they have often invested significant resources. As a result, these financial institutions may be inclined to resist replacing their legacy systems with our core software system. Our future financial performance will depend in part on the successful development, introduction and client acceptance of new and enhanced versions of our core software system and our other complementary products. A decline in demand for, or failure to achieve broad market acceptance of, our core software system or any enhanced version as a result of competition,

7


Table of Contents

technological change or otherwise, will have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

If we fail to expand our outsourcing business and other sources of recurring revenue, we may be unable to successfully implement our business strategy.

      We can host a financial institution’s data processing functions at our outsourcing centers. Our outsourcing centers currently serve clients using our core software and our Internet banking, ATM, cView, cash management, collections, automated clearing house, or ACH, processing, and check and item processing products. In the future, we plan to offer all of our products in our outsourcing centers and continue to market our outsourcing services aggressively.

      Our outsourcing services provide a source of recurring revenue which can grow as the number of accounts processed for a client increases. We also seek to generate recurring revenue through our licensing model, which generates additional fees for us as a client’s business grows or it adds more software applications, as well as through the provision of maintenance, support and other professional services. Our maintenance revenues are the largest of these revenue components, and we expect that these revenues will continue to be a significant portion of our total revenues as our client base grows due to their recurring nature. We anticipate that the revenue from outsourcing centers hosted by resellers will comprise a greater proportion of total revenues in future periods due to the amendment and restatement of our agreement with BISYS, Inc., which became effective as of September 1, 2003. To the extent we fail to persuade new or existing clients to purchase our outsourcing services or we are unable to offer some or all of our products to clients on an outsourced basis, we will be unable to implement our strategy and our revenue may be less predictable.

We have had few profitable quarters, and may never achieve sustained profitability.

      We were incorporated in May 1992 and did not release our first product until 1995. Accordingly, our prospects must be considered in light of the risks, expenses and difficulties frequently encountered by companies with limited operating histories. Although we have been profitable in some recent quarters, we may not be profitable in future periods, either on a short or long-term basis. We incurred operating losses of approximately $15.3 million, $10.3 million and $3.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2000, 2001 and 2002, respectively. As of December 31, 2003, we had an accumulated deficit of approximately $47.0 million. There can be no assurance that operating losses will not recur in the future, that we will ever sustain profitability on a quarterly or annual basis or that our actual results will meet our projections, expectations or announced guidance. To the extent that revenues do not grow at anticipated rates, increases in operating expenses precede or are not subsequently followed by commensurate increases in revenues or we are unable to adjust operating expense levels accordingly, our business, financial condition and results of operations will be materially adversely affected.

If we fail to adapt our products and services to changes in technology or in the marketplace, we could lose existing clients and be unable to attract new business.

      The markets for our software products and services are characterized by technological change, frequent new product introductions and evolving industry standards. The introduction of products embodying new technologies and the emergence of new industry standards can render our existing products obsolete and unmarketable in short periods of time. We expect new products and services, and enhancements to existing products and services, to continue to be developed and introduced by others, which will compete with, and reduce the demand for, our products and services. Our products’ life cycles are difficult to estimate. Our future success will depend, in part, on our ability to enhance our current products and to develop and introduce new products that keep pace with technological developments and emerging industry standards and to address the increasingly sophisticated needs of our clients. There can be no assurance that we will be successful in developing, marketing, licensing and selling new products or product enhancements that meet these changing demands, that we will not experience difficulties that could delay or prevent the successful development, introduction and marketing of these products or that our new products and product enhancements will adequately meet the demands of the marketplace and achieve market acceptance.

8


Table of Contents

We encounter a long sales and implementation cycle requiring significant capital commitments by our clients which they may be unwilling or unable to make.

      The implementation of our core software system involves significant capital commitments by our clients. Potential clients generally commit significant resources to an evaluation of available software and require us to expend substantial time, effort and money educating them as to the value of our software. Sales of our core processing software products require an extensive education and marketing effort throughout a client’s organization because decisions relating to licensing our core processing software generally involve the evaluation of the software by senior management and a significant number of client personnel in various functional areas, each having specific and often conflicting requirements.

      We may expend significant funds and management resources during the sales cycle and ultimately fail to close the sale. Our core software product sales cycle generally ranges between six to nine months, and our implementation cycle for our core software generally ranges between six to nine months. Our sales cycle for all of our products and services is subject to significant risks and delays over which we have little or no control, including:

  •  our clients’ budgetary constraints,
 
  •  the timing of our clients’ budget cycles and approval processes,
 
  •  our clients’ willingness to replace their core software solution vendor,
 
  •  the success and continued support of our strategic marketing partners’ sales efforts, and
 
  •  the timing and expiration of our clients’ current license agreements or outsourcing agreements for similar services.

      If we are unsuccessful in closing sales after expending significant funds and management resources or if we experience delays as discussed above, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We utilize certain key technologies from third parties, and may be unable to replace those technologies if they become obsolete or incompatible with our products.

      Our proprietary software is designed to work in conjunction with certain third-party software products, including Microsoft and Oracle relational databases. Although we believe that there are alternatives to these products generally available to us, any significant interruption in the supply of such third-party software could have a material adverse effect on our sales unless and until we can replace the functionality provided by these products. In addition, we are dependent upon these third parties’ abilities to enhance their current products, to develop new products on a timely and cost-effective basis and to respond to emerging industry standards and other technological changes. There can be no assurance that we would be able to replace the functionality provided by the third-party software currently offered in conjunction with our products in the event that such software becomes obsolete or incompatible with future versions of our products or is otherwise not adequately maintained or updated. The absence of, or any significant delay in, the replacement of that functionality could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Furthermore, delays in the release of new and upgraded versions of third-party software products, particularly the Oracle relational database management system, could have a material adverse effect on our revenues and results of operations. Because of the complexities inherent in developing sophisticated software products and the lengthy testing periods associated with these products, no assurance can be given that our future product introductions will not be delayed.

We operate in a competitive business environment, and if we are unable to compete effectively, we may face price reductions and decreased demand for our products.

      The market for our products and services is intensely competitive and subject to technological change. Competitors vary in size and in the scope and breadth of the products and services they offer. We encounter competition from a number of sources, all of which offer core software systems to the banking and credit union industry. We expect additional competition from other established and emerging companies as the market for core processing software solutions and complementary products continues to develop and expand.

9


Table of Contents

We also expect that competition will increase as a result of software industry consolidation, including particularly the acquisition of any of our competitors or any of the retail banking system providers by one of the larger service providers to the banking industry. We encounter competition in the United States from a number of sources, including Fiserv, Inc., Jack Henry & Associates, Inc., Fidelity National Financial Corporation and John H. Harland Company, all of which offer core processing systems or outsourcing alternatives to banks, thrifts and credit unions. Some of our current, and many of our potential, competitors have longer operating histories, greater name recognition, larger client bases and significantly greater financial, engineering, technical, marketing and other resources than we do. As a result, these companies may be able to respond more quickly to new or emerging technologies and changes in client demands or to devote greater resources to the development, promotion and sale of their products than we can.

      In addition, current and potential competitors have established or may establish cooperative relationships among themselves or with third parties to increase the ability of their products to address the needs of our prospective clients. Accordingly, it is possible that new competitors or alliances among competitors may emerge and acquire significant market share. We expect that the banking and credit union software market will continue to attract new competitors and new technologies, possibly involving alternative technologies that are more sophisticated and cost-effective than our technology. There can be no assurance that we will be able to compete successfully against current or future competitors or that competitive pressures faced by us will not materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our quarterly revenues, operating results and profitability will vary from quarter to quarter, which may result in volatility in our stock price.

      Our quarterly revenues, operating results and profitability have varied in the past and are likely to continue to vary significantly from quarter to quarter. This may lead to volatility in our stock price. These fluctuations are due to several factors relating to the license and sale of our products, including:

  •  the timing, size and nature of our licensing transactions,
 
  •  lengthy and unpredictable sales cycles,
 
  •  the timing of introduction and market acceptance of new products or product enhancements by us or our competitors,
 
  •  the timing of acquisitions by us of businesses and products,
 
  •  product and price competition,
 
  •  the relative proportions of revenues derived from license fees and services,
 
  •  changes in our operating expenses,
 
  •  software bugs or other product quality problems, and
 
  •  personnel changes and fluctuations in economic and financial market conditions.

      We believe that period-to-period comparisons of our results of operations are not necessarily meaningful. There can be no assurance that future revenues and results of operations will not vary substantially. It is also possible that in future quarters, our results of operations will be below the expectations of public market analysts or investors or our announced guidance. In either case, the price of our common stock could be materially adversely affected.

We face a lengthy sales cycle for our core software, which may cause fluctuations in our revenues from quarter to quarter.

      We may not be able to increase revenue or decrease expenses to meet expectations for a given quarter. We recognize software license revenues upon delivery and, if required by the underlying agreement, upon client acceptance, if such criteria is other than perfunctory, which does not always occur in the same quarter in which the software license agreement for the system is signed. As a result, we are constrained in our ability to increase our software license revenue in any quarter if there are unexpected delays in delivery or required acceptance of systems for which software licenses were signed in previous quarters. Implementation of our core software system typically occurs over six to nine months. Delays in the delivery, implementation or any

10


Table of Contents

required acceptance of our products could materially adversely affect our quarterly results of operations. Revenues from software license sales accounted for 33.5% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2003, 30.3% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2002 and 36.6% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2001. We expect that revenues from software license sales will continue to provide a significant percentage of our revenues in future periods, and our ability to close license sales, as well as the timing of those sales, may have a material impact on our quarterly results. In addition, increased sales and marketing expenses for any given quarter may negatively impact operating results of that quarter due to lack of recognition of associated revenues until the delivery of the product in a subsequent quarter.

Our level of fixed expenses may cause us to incur operating losses if we are unsuccessful in maintaining our current revenue levels.

      Our expense levels are based, in significant part, on our expectations as to future revenues and are largely fixed in the short term. As a result, we may be unable to adjust spending in a timely manner to compensate for any unexpected shortfall in revenues. Accordingly, any significant shortfall of revenues in relation to our expectations would have an immediate and materially adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, as we expand we would anticipate increasing our operating expenses to expand our installation, product development, sales and marketing and administrative organizations. The time of such expansion and the rate at which new personnel become productive could cause material losses to the extent we do not generate additional revenue.

We rely on our direct sales force to generate revenue, and may be unable to hire additional sales personnel in a timely manner.

      We rely primarily on our direct sales force to sell licenses of our core software system. We may need to hire additional sales, client care and implementation personnel in the near-term and beyond if we are to achieve revenue growth in the future. Competition for such personnel is intense, and there can be no assurance that we will be able to retain our existing sales, customer service and implementation personnel or will be able to attract, assimilate or retain additional highly qualified personnel in the future. If we are unable to hire or retain qualified sales personnel on a timely basis, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

We receive a portion of our revenues from relationships with strategic marketing partners, and if we lose one or more of these marketing partners or fail to add new ones it could have a negative impact on our business.

      We expect that revenues generated from the sale of our products and services by our strategic marketing partners will account for a meaningful portion of our revenues for the foreseeable future. In particular, we expect that BISYS, Inc., a major national outsourcing center, and Connecticut On-Line Computer Center, Inc., or COCC, a major regional outsourcing center, will account for a meaningful portion of our revenues over time. During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, BISYS represented approximately $5.8 million, or 9.1%, of our total revenues, and COCC represented approximately $1.5 million, or 2.4%, of our total revenues. On September 30, 2003, we amended and restated our software license agreement with BISYS, Inc., effective as of September 1, 2003. We expect that, as a result of this amendment and restatement, in the future BISYS will account for a greater portion of our revenues than it has historically.

      Our strategic marketing partners pay us license fees based on the volume of products and services that they sell. If we lose one or more of our major strategic marketing partners, we may be unable in a timely manner, or at all, to replace them with another entity with comparable client bases and user demographics, which would adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, we plan to supplement our existing distribution partners with other national and regional outsourcing centers. If we are unable to identify appropriate resellers and enter into arrangements with them for the outsourcing of our products and services to financial institutions, we may not be able to sustain or grow our business.

11


Table of Contents

If we do not retain our senior management and other key employees, we may not be able to successfully implement our business strategy.

      We have grown significantly in recent years, and our management remains concentrated in a small number of key employees. Our future success depends to a significant extent on our executive officers and key employees, including our sales force and software professionals, particularly project managers, software engineers and other senior technical personnel. The loss of the services of any of these individuals or group of individuals could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Competition for qualified personnel in the software industry is intense and we compete for these personnel with other software companies that have greater financial and other resources than we do. Our future success will depend in large part on our ability to attract, retain and motivate highly qualified personnel, and there can be no assurance that we will be able to do so. Any difficulty in hiring needed personnel could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We rely on internally developed software and systems as well as third-party products, any of which may contain errors and bugs.

      Our software may contain undetected errors, defects or bugs. Although we have not suffered significant harm from any errors or defects to date, we may discover significant errors or defects in the future that we may or may not be able to correct. Our products involve integration with products and systems developed by third parties. Complex software programs of third parties may contain undetected errors or bugs when they are first introduced or as new versions are released. There can be no assurance that errors will not be found in our existing or future products or third-party products upon which our products are dependent, with the possible result of delays in or loss of market acceptance of our products, diversion of our resources, injury to our reputation and increased service and warranty expenses and/or payment of damages.

We could be sued for contract or product liability claims and lawsuits may disrupt our business, divert management’s attention or have an adverse effect on our financial results.

      Failures in a client’s system could result in an increase in service and warranty costs or a claim for substantial damages against us. There can be no assurance that the limitations of liability set forth in our contracts would be enforceable or would otherwise protect us from liability for damages. We maintain general liability insurance coverage, including coverage for errors and omissions in excess of the applicable deductible amount. There can be no assurance that this coverage will continue to be available on acceptable terms or will be available in sufficient amounts to cover one or more large claims, or that the insurer will not deny coverage as to any future claim. The successful assertion of one or more large claims against us that exceeds available insurance coverage, or the occurrence of changes in our insurance policies, including premium increases or the imposition of large deductible or co-insurance requirements, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Furthermore, litigation, regardless of its outcome, could result in substantial cost to us and divert management’s attention from our operations. Any contract liability claim or litigation against us could, therefore, have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, because many of our projects are business-critical projects for financial institutions, a failure or inability to meet a client’s expectations could seriously damage our reputation and affect our ability to attract new business.

Government regulation of our business could cause us to incur significant expenses, and failure to comply with applicable regulations could make our business less efficient or impossible.

      The financial services industry is subject to extensive and complex federal and state regulation. Financial institutions, including banks, thrifts and credit unions, operate under high levels of governmental supervision. Our clients must ensure that our products and services work within the extensive and evolving regulatory requirements applicable to them, including those under federal and state truth-in-lending and truth-in-deposit rules, usury laws, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing Act, the Electronic Fund Transfer Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the Bank Secrecy Act, the Community Reinvestment Act, the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999, the USA Patriot Act and other state and local laws and regulations. The compliance of our

12


Table of Contents

products and services with these requirements may depend on a variety of factors, including the product at issue and whether the client is a bank, thrift, credit union or other type of financial institution.

      Neither federal depository institution regulators nor other federal or state regulators of financial services require us to obtain any licenses. We are subject to examination by federal depository institution regulators under the Bank Service Company Act and the Examination Parity and Year 2000 Readiness for Financial Institutions Act. Although we believe we are not subject to direct supervision by federal and state banking agencies relating to other regulations, we have from time to time agreed to examinations of our business and operations by these agencies. These regulators have broad supervisory authority to remedy any shortcomings identified in any such examination.

      Federal, state or foreign authorities could also adopt laws, rules or regulations relating to the financial services industry that affect our business, such as requiring us or our clients to comply with data, record keeping and processing and other requirements. It is possible that laws and regulations may be enacted or modified with respect to the Internet, covering issues such as end-user privacy, pricing, content, characteristics, taxation and quality of services and products. Adoption of these laws, rules or regulations could render our business or operations more costly and burdensome or less efficient and could require us to modify our current or future products or services.

Our limited ability to protect our proprietary technology and other rights may adversely affect our ability to compete.

      We rely on a combination of copyright, trademark and trade secret laws, as well as licensing agreements, third-party nondisclosure agreements and other contractual provisions and technical measures to protect our intellectual property rights. There can be no assurance that these protections will be adequate to prevent our competitors from copying or reverse-engineering our products, or that our competitors will not independently develop technologies that are substantially equivalent or superior to our technology. To protect our trade secrets and other proprietary information, we require employees, consultants, advisors and collaborators to enter into confidentiality agreements. We cannot assure you that these agreements will provide meaningful protection for our trade secrets, know-how or other proprietary information in the event of any unauthorized use, misappropriation or disclosure of such trade secrets, know-how or other proprietary information. We do not include in our products any mechanism to prevent unauthorized copying and any such unauthorized copying could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. We have no patents, and existing copyright laws afford only limited protection for our intellectual property rights and may not protect such rights in the event competitors independently develop products similar to ours. In addition, the laws of certain countries in which our products are or may be licensed do not protect our products and intellectual property rights to the same extent as the laws of the United States.

If we are found to infringe the proprietary rights of others, we could be required to redesign our products, pay royalties or enter into license agreements with third parties.

      Although we have never been the subject of a material intellectual property dispute, there can be no assurance that a third party will not assert that our technology violates its intellectual property rights in the future. As the number of software products in our target market increases and the functionality of these products further overlap, we believe that software developers may become increasingly subject to infringement claims. Any claims, whether with or without merit, could:

  •  be expensive and time consuming to defend,
 
  •  cause us to cease making, licensing or using products that incorporate the challenged intellectual property,
 
  •  require us to redesign our products, if feasible,
 
  •  divert management’s attention and resources, and
 
  •  require us to enter into royalty or licensing agreements in order to obtain the right to use necessary technologies.

13


Table of Contents

      There can be no assurance that third parties will not assert infringement claims against us in the future with respect to our current or future products or that any such assertion will not require us to enter into royalty arrangements (if available) or litigation that could be costly to us.

We have entered into and may continue to enter into or seek to enter into business combinations and acquisitions which may be difficult to integrate, disrupt our business, dilute stockholder value or divert management attention.

      Since 2000, we have acquired several businesses. As part of our business strategy, we may enter into additional business combinations and acquisitions in the future. We have limited experience in making acquisitions. In addition, acquisitions are typically accompanied by a number of risks, including:

  •  the difficulty of integrating the operations and personnel of the acquired companies,
 
  •  the maintenance of acceptable standards, controls, procedures and policies,
 
  •  the potential disruption of our ongoing business and distraction of management,
 
  •  the impairment of relationships with employees and clients as a result of any integration of new management and other personnel,
 
  •  the inability to maintain relationships with clients of the acquired business,
 
  •  the difficulty of incorporating acquired technology and rights into our products and services,
 
  •  the failure to achieve the expected benefits of the combination or acquisition,
 
  •  expenses related to the acquisition,
 
  •  potential unknown liabilities associated with acquired businesses, and
 
  •  unanticipated expenses related to acquired technology and its integration into existing technology.

      If we are not successful in completing acquisitions that we may pursue in the future, we would be required to reevaluate our growth strategy and we may have incurred substantial expenses and devoted significant management time and resources in seeking to complete the acquisitions. In addition, with future acquisitions, we could use substantial portions of our available cash as all or a portion of the purchase price. We could also issue additional securities as consideration for these acquisitions, which could cause our stockholders to suffer significant dilution. Any future acquisitions may not generate additional revenue for us.

If we fail to effectively manage our growth, our financial results could be adversely affected.

      We have expanded our operations rapidly in recent years. For example, our aggregate revenues increased from approximately $27.3 million in 2001 to approximately $44.3 million in 2002 and approximately $63.9 million in 2003. As of March 31, 2004, we had 413 employees, up from 278 as of December 31, 2002. In addition, we continue to explore ways to extend our target markets, including to larger financial institutions, international clients, and clients in the payroll services, insurance and brokerage industries. Our growth may place a strain on our management systems, information systems and resources. Our ability to successfully offer products and services and implement our business plan requires adequate information systems and resources and oversight from our senior management. We will need to continue to improve our financial and managerial controls, reporting systems and procedures as we continue to grow and expand our business. As we grow, we must also continue to hire, train, supervise and manage new employees. We may not be able to hire, train, supervise and manage sufficient personnel or develop management and operating systems to manage our expansion effectively. If we are unable to manage our growth, our operations and financial results could be adversely affected.

The requirements of being a public company may strain our resources and distract management.

      As a public company, we are subject to the reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. These requirements may place a strain on our systems and resources. The Securities Exchange Act requires, among other things, that we file annual, quarterly and current reports with respect to our business and financial condition. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires, among other things, that we maintain effective disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls for financial

14


Table of Contents

reporting. We currently do not have an internal audit group. In order to maintain and improve the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting, significant resources and management oversight will be required. As a result, management’s attention may be diverted from other business concerns, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. In addition, we will need to hire additional accounting and financial staff with appropriate public company experience and technical accounting knowledge and we cannot assure you that we will be able to do so in a timely fashion.

The design of other core vendors’ software or their use of financial incentives may make it more difficult for clients to use our complementary products.

      Currently, some core software vendors design their software so that it is difficult or infeasible to use third-party complementary products, including ours. Some core software vendors use financial incentives to encourage their core software clients to purchase their proprietary complementary products. For example, in the past a core software vendor has charged disproportionately high fees to integrate third-party complementary products such as ours, thereby providing a financial incentive for clients of that vendor’s core software to use its complementary products. We have responded to this practice by emphasizing to prospective clients the features and functionality of our products, lowering our price or offering to perform the relevant integration services ourselves. We cannot assure you that these competitors, or other vendors of core software, will not begin or continue to construct technical, or implement financial, obstacles to the purchase of our products. These obstacles could make it more difficult for us to sell our complementary products and could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.

Operational failures in our outsourcing centers could cause us to lose clients.

      Damage or destruction that interrupts our provision of outsourcing services could damage our relationship with our clients and may cause us to incur substantial additional expense to repair or replace damaged equipment. Although we have installed back-up systems and procedures to prevent or reduce disruption, we cannot assure you that we will not suffer a prolonged interruption of our data processing services. In the event that an interruption of our network extends for more than several hours, we may experience data loss or a reduction in revenues by reason of such interruption. In addition, a significant interruption of service could have a negative impact on our reputation and could lead our present and potential clients to choose service providers other than us.

Unauthorized disclosure of data, whether through breach of our computer systems or otherwise, could expose us to protracted and costly litigation or cause us to lose clients.

      In our outsourcing centers, we collect and store sensitive data, including names, addresses, social security numbers, checking and savings account numbers and payment history records, such as account closures and returned checks. If a person penetrates our network security or otherwise misappropriates sensitive data, we could be subject to liability or our business could be interrupted. Penetration of the network security of our outsourcing centers could have a negative impact on our reputation and could lead our present and potential clients to choose service providers other than us.

We may need additional capital in the future, which may not be available to us, and if we raise additional capital, it may dilute your ownership in us.

      We may need to raise additional funds through public or private debt or equity financings in order to meet various objectives, such as:

  •  taking advantage of growth opportunities, including more rapid expansion,
 
  •  acquiring businesses and products,
 
  •  making capital improvements to increase our servicing capacity,
 
  •  developing new services or products, and
 
  •  responding to competitive pressures.

15


Table of Contents

      In addition, we may need additional financing if we decide to undertake new sales and/or marketing initiatives, if we are required to defend or enforce our intellectual property rights, or if sales of our products do not meet our expectations.

      Any debt incurred by us could impair our ability to obtain additional financing for working capital, capital expenditures or further acquisitions. Covenants governing any indebtedness we incur would likely restrict our ability to take specific actions, including our ability to pay dividends or distributions on, or redeem or repurchase, our capital stock, enter into transactions with affiliates, merge, consolidate or sell our assets or make capital expenditure investments. In addition, the use of a substantial portion of the cash generated by our operations to cover debt service obligations and any security interests we grant on our assets could limit our financial and business flexibility.

      Any additional capital raised through the sale of equity or convertible debt securities may dilute your ownership percentage in us. Furthermore, any additional debt or equity financing we may need may not be available on terms favorable to us, or at all. If future financing is not available or is not available on acceptable terms, we may not be able to raise additional capital, which could significantly limit our ability to implement our business plan. In addition, we may have to issue securities, including debt securities, that may have rights, preferences and privileges senior to our common stock.

Risks Relating to this Offering

The price of our common stock may be volatile.

      In the past three years, technology stocks listed on the Nasdaq National Market have experienced high levels of volatility and significant declines in value from their historic highs. The trading price of our common stock following this offering may fluctuate substantially. The price of the common stock that will prevail in the market after this offering may be higher or lower than the price you pay, depending on many factors, some of which are beyond our control and may not be related to our operating performance. The fluctuations could cause you to lose part or all of your investment in our shares of common stock. The factors that could cause fluctuations in the trading price of our common stock include, but are not limited to, the following:

  •  price and volume fluctuations in the overall stock market from time to time,
 
  •  significant volatility in the market price and trading volume of financial services companies,
 
  •  actual or anticipated changes in our earnings or fluctuations in our operating results or in the expectations of securities analysts,
 
  •  general economic conditions and trends,
 
  •  major catastrophic events,
 
  •  loss of a significant client or clients,
 
  •  sales of large blocks of our stock, or
 
  •  departures of key personnel.

      In the past, following periods of volatility in the market price of a company’s securities, securities class action litigation has often been brought against that company. Due to the potential volatility of our stock price, we may therefore be the target of securities litigation in the future. Securities litigation could result in substantial costs and divert management’s attention and resources from our business.

If a substantial number of shares of our common stock become available for sale and are sold in a short period of time, the market price of our common stock could decline significantly.

      If our stockholders sell substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market, the market price of our common stock could decrease significantly. The perception in the public market that our stockholders might sell shares of common stock could also depress the market price of our common stock. On May 24, 2004, 2,683,111 shares of our common stock will become eligible for sale in the public market upon expiration of lock-up agreements entered into in connection with our initial public offering. Some of our stockholders (including some of those who entered into agreements in connection with our initial public

16


Table of Contents

offering) will enter into lock-up agreements in connection with this offering. After all of the agreements entered into in connection with this offering expire (which will occur 90 days after the date of the final prospectus for this offering), an additional 1,417,331 shares of our common stock will be eligible for sale in the public market. In addition, as of March 31, 2004, we had options to purchase a total of 3,248,078 shares of our common stock outstanding under our 1994 Stock Incentive Plan, 2000 Stock Incentive Plan and 2003 Stock Incentive Plan, of which 1,562,370 were vested. We have filed Form S-8 registration statements to register all of the shares of our common stock issuable under these plans. The market price of shares of our common stock may drop significantly when the restrictions on resale by our existing stockholders lapse and our stockholders are able to sell shares of our common stock into the market. A decline in the price of shares of our common stock might impede our ability to raise capital through the issuance of additional shares of our common stock or other equity securities, and may cause you to lose part or all of your investment in our shares of common stock.

If you purchase shares of common stock sold in this offering, you will experience immediate dilution.

      If you purchase shares of common stock in this offering, you will experience immediate dilution of $17.17 per share, because the price that you pay will be substantially greater than the net tangible book value per share of common stock that you acquire. This dilution is due in large part to the fact that our earlier investors paid substantially less than the price of the shares being sold in this offering when they purchased their shares of our capital stock. You will experience additional dilution upon the exercise of stock options to purchase common stock and the issuance of restricted stock to our employees under our equity incentive plans.

We have broad discretion in the use of the proceeds of this offering.

      The net proceeds from this offering will be used, as determined by management in its sole discretion, for working capital and general corporate purposes, as well as for the possible acquisition of additional businesses and technologies that are complementary to our current or future business. However, we have not determined the specific allocation of the net proceeds among the various uses described in this prospectus. Our management will have broad discretion over the use and investment of the net proceeds of this offering, and, accordingly, investors in this offering will need to rely upon the judgment of our management with respect to the use of proceeds, with only limited information concerning management’s specific intentions.

Insiders will continue to have substantial control over us after this offering and could limit your ability to influence the outcome of key transactions, including a change of control.

      Our principal stockholders, directors and executive officers, and entities affiliated with them, beneficially own approximately 41.7% of the outstanding shares of our common stock as of March 15, 2004, and will beneficially own approximately 24.8% of the outstanding shares of our common stock after this offering. Accordingly, these stockholders, if acting together, would be able to influence or control matters requiring approval by our stockholders, including the election of directors and the approval of mergers, acquisitions or other extraordinary transactions. They may also have interests that differ from yours and may vote in a way with which you disagree and which may be adverse to your interests. The concentration of ownership may have the effect of delaying, preventing or deterring a change of control of our company, could deprive our stockholders of an opportunity to receive a premium for their common stock as part of a sale of our company and might ultimately affect the market price of our common stock.

Some provisions in our certificate of incorporation and by-laws may deter third parties from
acquiring us.

      Our restated certificate of incorporation and our amended and restated by-laws contain provisions that may make the acquisition of our company more difficult without the approval of our board of directors, including the following:

  •  our board of directors is classified into three classes, each of which serves for a staggered three year term,

17


Table of Contents

  •  only our board of directors, the chairman of our board of directors or our president may call special meetings of our stockholders,
 
  •  our stockholders may take action only at a meeting of our stockholders and not by written consent,
 
  •  we have authorized undesignated preferred stock, the terms of which may be established and shares of which may be issued without stockholder approval,
 
  •  our stockholders have only limited rights to amend our by-laws, and
 
  •  we require advance notice requirements for stockholder proposals.

      These anti-takeover defenses could discourage, delay or prevent a transaction involving a change in control of our company. These provisions could also discourage proxy contests and make it more difficult for you and other stockholders to elect directors of your choosing and cause us to take other corporate actions you desire.

Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law may delay, defer or prevent a change in control that our stockholders might consider to be in their best interest.

      We are subject to Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law which, subject to certain exceptions, prohibits “business combinations” between a publicly-held Delaware corporation and an “interested stockholder,” which is generally defined as a stockholder who becomes a beneficial owner of 15% or more of a Delaware corporation’s voting stock for a three-year period following the date that such stockholder became an interested stockholder. Section 203 could have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of our company that our stockholders might consider to be in their best interests.

SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

      This prospectus, including the sections entitled “Prospectus Summary,” “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Business” contains forward-looking statements. These statements relate to future events or our future financial performance, and involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause our actual results, levels of activity, performance or achievements to be materially different from any future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements expressed or implied by these forwards-looking statements. In some cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by terminology such as “may,” “should,” “expects,” “plans,” “intends,” “predicts,” “anticipates,” “believes,” “estimates,” “potential,” “continue” or the negative of such terms or other comparable terminology. These statements are only predictions. You should not place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements. Actual events or results may differ materially. In evaluating these statements, you should specifically consider various important factors, including the risks outlined under “Risk Factors.” These factors may cause our actual results to differ materially from any forward-looking statement.

      Although we believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot guarantee future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements. We are under no duty to update any of the forward-looking statements after the date of this prospectus to conform such statements to actual results.

18


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS

      We estimate that our net proceeds from the sale of the 1,000,000 shares of common stock that we are offering hereby will be approximately $21.5 million after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses, assuming an offering price of $23.15, based on the last reported sale price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on April 21, 2004. We will not receive any of the proceeds of the sale of shares of common stock by the selling stockholders.

      We currently intend to use the estimated net proceeds from this offering for working capital and general corporate purposes, including marketing of our outsourcing services, selling our products and services to larger financial institutions and potential acquisitions of businesses, products or technologies that are complementary to our own. Currently, we have no specific plans or commitments with respect to any acquisition. We cannot assure you that we will complete any acquisitions or that, if completed, any acquisition will be successful.

      We have not yet identified the amounts we plan to spend on each of these areas or the timing of expenditures. We will retain broad discretion in the allocation and use of the net proceeds of this offering. Pending application of the net proceeds, as described above, we will invest any remaining proceeds in short-term, investment-grade, interest-bearing securities.

19


Table of Contents

PRICE RANGE OF COMMON STOCK

      Since November 26, 2003, our common stock has traded on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol “OPEN.” The following table sets forth the high and low sales prices of our common stock, as reported on the Nasdaq National Market, for each of the periods listed.

                   
High Low


Fiscal 2003
               
 
Fourth Quarter (commencing November 26, 2003)
  $ 19.78     $ 15.65  
Fiscal 2004
               
 
First Quarter
    26.07       17.40  
 
Second Quarter (through April 21, 2004)
    24.78       21.75  

      The last reported sale price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on April 21, 2004 was $23.15 per share. As of March 31, 2004, we had approximately 93 holders of record of our common stock.

DIVIDEND POLICY

      We have never declared or paid any cash dividends on our capital stock and we do not anticipate paying cash dividends in the foreseeable future. We currently intend to retain future earnings, if any, to fund the expansion and growth of our business. Payment of future cash dividends, if any, will be at the discretion of our board of directors after taking into account various factors, including our financial condition, operating results, current and anticipated cash needs and plans for expansion.

20


Table of Contents

CAPITALIZATION

      The following table sets forth the capitalization as of December 31, 2003 on:

  •  an actual basis, and
 
  •  an as adjusted basis to give effect to the sale of 1,000,000 shares of our common stock in this offering and the deduction of the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and our offering expenses, assuming an offering price of $23.15, based on the last reported sale price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on April 21, 2004.

      The table does not reflect:

  •  the exercise by the underwriters of their over-allotment option granted by us to purchase additional shares of our common stock in this offering,
 
  •  3,248,078 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options as of March 31, 2004 at a weighted average exercise price of $8.74 per share, of which options to purchase 1,562,370 shares are exercisable, and
 
  •  5,249,230 additional shares of common stock reserved for issuance under our 1994 Stock Incentive Plan, 2000 Stock Incentive Plan, 2003 Stock Incentive Plan and 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

      You should read the following table together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and the consolidated financial statements and related notes, which are included elsewhere in this prospectus.

                       
December 31, 2003

Actual As Adjusted


(in thousands)
Stockholders’ equity:
               
 
Preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 5,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued and outstanding on an actual and as adjusted basis
           
 
Common stock, $0.01 par value; 95,000,000 shares authorized, 16,786,329 shares issued and outstanding on an actual basis, 17,786,329 shares issued and outstanding on an as adjusted basis
    168       178  
 
Additional paid-in capital
    152,274       173,757  
 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
    (28 )     (28 )
 
Accumulated deficit
    (46,995 )     (46,995 )
     
     
 
   
Total stockholders’ equity
    105,419       126,912  
     
     
 
     
Total capitalization
    105,419       126,912  
     
     
 

21


Table of Contents

DILUTION

      As of December 31, 2003, our net tangible book value was $84,887,000, or $5.06 per share of common stock. After giving effect to the sale of our common stock in this offering, and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses, our as adjusted net tangible book value as of December 31, 2003, would have been $106,379,500, or $5.98 per share of common stock. This represents an immediate increase in such net tangible book value of $0.92 per share to existing stockholders and an immediate dilution of $17.17 per share to new investors participating in this offering. The following table illustrates the per share dilution:

                   
Assumed public offering price per share (based on the last reported sale price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on April 21, 2004)
          $ 23.15  
Historical net tangible book value per share as of December 31, 2003
  $ 5.06          
 
Increase per share attributable to new investors
    0.92          
As adjusted net tangible book value per share after this offering
          $ 5.98  
             
 
Dilution per share to new investors participating in this offering
          $ 17.17  
             
 

      The following table summarizes, on an as adjusted basis as of December 31, 2003, the differences between the total cash consideration paid and the average price per share paid by existing stockholders and new investors with respect to the number of shares of our common stock purchased from us.

                                           
Shares purchased Total consideration


Average price
Number Percent Amount Percent per share





Existing stockholders
    16,786,329       94.4 %   $ 155,823,436       87.1 %   $ 9.28  
New investors
    1,000,000       5.6       23,150,000       12.9       23.15  
     
     
     
     
     
 
 
Total
    17,786,329       100 %     178,973,436       100 %     10.06  

      The foregoing discussion and tables assume no exercise of any stock options and no issuance of shares reserved for future issuance under our stock incentive plans. As of December 31, 2003, there were 16,786,329 shares of common stock outstanding, which excludes:

  •  2,910,292 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options as of December 31, 2003 at a weighted average exercise price of $5.32 per share, and
 
  •  5,894,927 additional shares of common stock reserved for issuance under our 1994 Stock Incentive Plan, 2000 Stock Incentive Plan, 2003 Stock Incentive Plan and 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

      To the extent stock options are exercised and the underlying shares of common stock are issued, there will be further dilution to new investors. In addition, we may grant additional stock options or issue other equity securities in the future that may be dilutive to investors in this offering.

      Assuming the exercise in full of the underwriters’ option to purchase 650,907 shares of common stock to cover over-allotments, our as adjusted net tangible book value as of December 31, 2003 would have been $121,447,997, or $6.59 per share. This represents an immediate increase in the net tangible book value of $1.53 per share to existing stockholders and immediate dilution of $16.56 per share to new investors participating in this offering.

22


Table of Contents

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

(in thousands, except per share data)

      The selected financial data set forth below as of December 31, 2002 and 2003 and for the three years ended December 31, 2003 are derived from our financial statements, which appear elsewhere in this prospectus and which have been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, independent accountants. The selected financial data set forth below as of December 31, 1999, 2000 and 2001 and for the two years ended December 31, 2000 are derived from our audited financial statements which are not included in this prospectus. Since June 2000, we have acquired six businesses, as more fully described in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. These acquisitions have significantly affected our revenues, results of operations and financial condition. The operating results of each business acquired have been, or in the case of the acquisition of Maxxar Corporation, will be included in our financial statements from the respective dates of acquisition.

      The historical results presented below are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for any future period. The data set forth below should be read in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our financial statements, including the notes thereto, included elsewhere in this prospectus.

                                             
Year Ended December 31,

1999 2000 2001 2002 2003





Statement of Operations Data:
                                       
Revenues:
                                       
 
Software license
  $ 5,347     $ 8,595     $ 9,971     $ 13,449     $ 21,391  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    8,705       11,625       17,295       30,896       42,461  
     
     
     
     
     
 
   
Total revenues
    14,052       20,220       27,266       44,345       63,852  
     
     
     
     
     
 
Cost of revenues:
                                       
 
Software license
    1,566       2,165       1,592       3,152       5,341  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    6,261       7,229       10,084       18,430       23,540  
     
     
     
     
     
 
   
Total cost of revenues
    7,827       9,394       11,676       21,582       28,881  
     
     
     
     
     
 
Operating expenses (includes restricted stock expense and related taxes of $3,444 for the year ended December 31, 2003)
    11,260       26,152       25,929       25,773       33,471  
     
     
     
     
     
 
Income (loss) from operations
    (5,035 )     (15,326 )     (10,339 )     (3,010 )     1,500  
Interest and other income, net
    320       661       428       145       43  
     
     
     
     
     
 
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (4,715 )     (14,665 )     (9,911 )     (2,865 )     1,543  
 
Income tax benefit (provision)
                250       (32 )     (234 )
     
     
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss)
  $ (4,715 )   $ (14,665 )   $ (9,661 )   $ (2,897 )     1,309  
Preferred stock accretion charge(1)
                            (31,500 )
     
     
     
     
     
 
Net loss attributable to common stockholders
  $ (4,715 )   $ (14,665 )   $ (9,661 )   $ (2,897 )   $ (30,191 )
     
     
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss) per common share
                                       
 
— Basic
  $ (2.92 )   $ (7.42 )   $ (4.71 )   $ (1.18 )   $ (7.74 )
 
— Diluted
    (2.92 )     (7.42 )     (4.71 )     (1.18 )   $ (7.74 )
Weighted average common shares used to compute net income (loss) per common share
                                       
 
— Basic
    1,616       1,977       2,051       2,453       3,903  
 
— Diluted
    1,616       1,977       2,051       2,453       3,903  

23


Table of Contents

                                         
December 31,

1999 2000 2001 2002 2003





Balance Sheet Data:
                                       
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 5,225     $ 8,522     $ 11,552     $ 11,414     $ 84,953  
Working capital
    3,008       5,051       3,261       1,486       73,084  
Total assets
    10,027       20,905       33,745       35,839       133,071  
Long-term debt, current portion
                748       750        
Long-term debt, less current portion
                      700        
Mandatorily Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
          20,084       31,100       31,100        
Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
    24,740       24,744       26,480       26,480        
Stockholders’ equity (deficit)
    (19,204 )     (33,751 )     (40,699 )     (43,261 )     105,419  


(1)  The conversion formula for our Series F preferred stock provided for adjustment of the Series F preferred stock conversion price in the event that our initial public offering price was less than $27.03 per share. Holders of Series F preferred stock received shares of common stock from the initial public offering with an aggregate value of $62,600,000. The recorded value of Series F preferred stock was $31,100,000 and as a result, upon the closing of our initial public offering, we recorded an accretion charge of $31,500,000 in stockholders’ equity (deficit). This accretion charge resulted in a non-cash deduction from income attributable to holders of common stock and a deduction in related earnings per share.

24


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS

OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

      The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with, and are derived from, our consolidated financial statements and related notes appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. In addition to historical information, this discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions, which could cause actual results to differ materially from management’s expectations. Important factors that could cause these differences include those described in “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this prospectus.

      We use the terms “Open Solutions,” “we,” “us” and “our” to refer to the business of Open Solutions Inc. and our subsidiaries. All references to years, unless otherwise noted, refer to our fiscal years, which end on December 31.

Overview

      We are a provider of software and services that allow financial institutions to compete and service their customers more effectively. We develop, market, license and support an enterprise-wide suite of software and services that perform a financial institution’s data processing and information management functions, including account, transaction, lending, operations, back office, client information and reporting. Our complementary products and services supplement our core software to provide our clients with fully-integrated business intelligence, customer relationship management, or CRM, check imaging, Internet banking and cash management, general ledger and profitability, loan origination, interactive voice solutions and check and item processing functions. Our software can be operated either by the financial institution itself, on an outsourced basis in one of our outsourcing centers or through an outsourcing center hosted by one of our resellers. Substantially all of our historical revenue has been generated through the licensing of our core software and our complementary products and the provision of related services and maintenance to small and mid-size commercial banks and thrifts and credit unions of all sizes.

      We derive revenues from two primary sources:

  •  sales of licenses for our core software and complementary products, and
 
  •  fees from installation, training, maintenance and support services, as well as fees generated from our outsourcing centers and the outsourcing centers hosted by our resellers.

      Our revenues have grown from approximately $14.1 million in 1999 to approximately $63.9 million in 2003. This growth has resulted primarily from internal expansion supplemented by strategic acquisitions, through which we have developed and acquired new products and services and have expanded the number of clients using one or more of our products to approximately 1,300 financial institutions as of December 31, 2003.

      Software license revenue includes fees received from the licensing of application software. We license our proprietary software products under standard agreements which typically provide our clients with a perpetual non-exclusive, non-transferable right to use the software for a single financial institution upon payment of a license fee.

      We generate service and maintenance fees by converting clients to our core software suite, installing our software, assisting our clients in operating the applications, modifying and updating the software and providing outsourcing services. Our software license agreements typically provide for five years of support and maintenance. We perform outsourcing services through our two outsourcing centers and our check and item processing centers. Revenues from outsourcing center services and the check and item processing centers are derived from monthly usage fees, typically under three to five-year service contracts with our clients.

      We derive other revenues from hardware sales and client reimbursement of out-of-pocket costs. We have entered into agreements with several hardware manufacturers under which we sell computer hardware and related services, primarily to our check imaging clients. Client reimbursements represent direct costs paid to third parties primarily for data communication, postage and travel.

25


Table of Contents

      We expect that our revenues from installation, training, maintenance, support services, our outsourcing centers and the outsourcing centers hosted by our resellers will continue to expand as our base of clients expands. Our maintenance revenues are the largest of these revenue components, and we expect that these revenues, due to their recurring nature, will continue to be a significant portion of our total revenue as our client base grows.

      We anticipate that the revenue from outsourcing centers hosted by our resellers will comprise a greater proportion of total revenues in future periods due to the expansion of our relationship with BISYS, Inc. Pursuant to our agreement with BISYS signed on September 30, 2003, BISYS has agreed to pay us aggregate minimum license fees of approximately $27.7 million through June 2006, including $7.2 million in fiscal year 2004. BISYS is obligated to pay us these license fees in quarterly installments.

      In November 2000, Enserv, Inc., a small consulting firm, filed a complaint against us, alleging that we breached the terms of a value-added reseller agreement. As of December 31, 2002, we had accrued $50,000 related to this complaint. On October 31, 2003, we and Enserv settled this litigation. Pursuant to the settlement, which includes mutual releases of the parties: (1) we made a payment to Enserv in the amount of $233,333; and (2) we and Enserv entered into a consulting agreement whereby Enserv is obligated to provide technical consulting services to us for two years for which Enserv will be paid $133,333 per year. Based on the terms of this agreement, we have recorded a settlement expense of $183,333 in the third quarter of 2003, and we are expensing the remaining $266,666 consulting fees ratably during the twenty-four month contract term. We have the right to cancel the consulting agreement if Enserv does not perform under the terms of the agreement.

      In May 2003, we issued an aggregate of 680,530 shares of common stock to 19 of our employees under our 2000 Stock Incentive Plan. The shares of common stock issued to each of these individuals vested at the end of seven years or vest immediately upon a change in control or initial public offerings. Prior to the closing of our initial public offering, we were recording a charge each quarter of approximately $117,000 based on amortization over seven years. This charge was accelerated on the completion of our initial public offering, resulting in a non-cash charge to our statement of operations in the fourth quarter of 2003 of approximately $3.0 million for the unamortized balance of deferred compensation. We also recorded employer tax expense of approximately $168,000 related to the restricted stock in the fourth quarter of 2003.

      In the second, third and fourth quarters of 2003, certain grants of stock options were made at exercise prices less than the fair market value of our common stock and, as a result, we recorded approximately $49,000, $98,000 and $99,000 of stock compensation expense, respectively. We will continue recording a charge each quarter of $101,000 based on amortization over the four-year vesting period of these stock options.

      The conversion formula for our Series F preferred stock provided for adjustment of the Series F preferred stock conversion price in the event that our initial public offering price was less than $27.03 per share. Upon the closing of our initial public offering in December 2003, the holders of Series F preferred stock received shares of common stock with an aggregate value of approximately $62,600,000. The recorded value of the Series F preferred stock was $31,100,000 and as a result, on the closing of our initial public offering, we recorded an accretion charge of $31,500,000 in stockholders’ equity (deficit). This accretion charge resulted in a non-cash deduction from income attributable to holders of our common stock and a deduction in related earnings per share.

Application of Critical Accounting Policies

      The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, which require that management make numerous estimates and assumptions. Actual results could differ from those estimates and assumptions, impacting our reported results of operations and financial position. Our significant accounting policies are more fully described in Note 2 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The critical accounting policies described below are those that are most important to the depiction of our financial condition and

26


Table of Contents

results of operations and their application requires management’s most subjective judgment in making estimates about the effect of matters that are inherently uncertain.
 
Revenue Recognition

      We generate revenues from licensing the rights to use our software products and certain third-party software products to clients. We also generate revenues from installation, training, maintenance and support services provided to clients, and from outsourcing center services and hardware sales related to our check imaging business.

      We recognize revenue in accordance with AICPA Statement of Position 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition. Under SOP 97-2, we recognize software license revenue when a noncancelable license agreement has been executed, fees are fixed and determinable, the software has been delivered, accepted by the client if acceptance is required by the contract and other than perfunctory, and collection is considered probable. The software licenses are sold in conjunction with professional services for installation, training, maintenance and support. For these arrangements, a portion of the total contract value is attributed first to the maintenance arrangement based on its fair value, which is derived from renewal rates. Another portion of the contract value is then attributed to installation and training services based on estimated fair value, which is derived from rates charged for similar services provided on a stand-alone basis multiplied by estimated hours to complete. Our software license agreements generally do not require significant modification or customization of the underlying software, and accordingly, installation and training services are not considered essential to functionality. The remainder of the total contract value is then attributed to the software licenses based on the residual method described in SOP 98-9, Modification of SOP 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition, With Respect to Certain Transactions. The estimated hours and hourly rate for installation and training services affect the timing and amount of revenue recognized from license fees and installation and training services. Due to the uncertainties inherent in the estimation process, actual hours to complete installation and training services or the estimated hourly rate of these services may differ from estimates. If customization of our software is required, we recognize revenue using the percentage-of-completion method. The complexity of some software license agreements requires us to routinely apply judgments regarding the application of software recognition accounting principles to specific agreements and transactions.

      Revenues from software maintenance are typically generated under five-year agreements and are recognized ratably over the life of the agreements. Revenues from installation and training services are recognized as services are performed. We calculate revenue recognition for installation and training services based on the ratio of hours incurred to estimated total hours for the project. Accordingly, we must estimate the hours to complete the installation and training, and it is possible that estimates may be revised. These revisions are recognized in the period in which the revisions are determined, and changes in these estimates could have a material effect on our financial statements.

      Deferred revenue is comprised of payments received related to product delivery, maintenance and other services, which have been paid by customers prior to the recognition of revenue. Deferred revenue relates primarily to cash received for maintenance contracts in advance of services performed, which is recognized as revenue ratably as services are performed. Deferred costs are comprised of costs incurred prior to the recognition of related revenue.

      Data center revenues associated with allowing customers to utilize our software products on an outsourced basis are recognized in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101, Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements. Revenues associated with installation of data center arrangements are recognized as services are performed, and revenues from data center services are recognized over the term of the arrangement, typically three to five years. The total contract value is allocated based on the relative fair value of the installation and data center services.

      We are receiving payments under certain license and marketing agreements with resellers. We have provided a master license to our two primary resellers BISYS, Inc. and Connecticut On-Line Computer Center, Inc., or COCC, and do not have any other continuing obligation to provide additional products or services, other than the provision of client support and maintenance. We recognize revenue when the revenue

27


Table of Contents

recognition criteria under SOP No. 97-2 are met, including when evidence of an arrangement exists, fees are fixed and determinable, collectibility is reasonably assured, and delivery has occurred.

      We recognize hardware revenue related to our check imaging products on a percentage-of-completion basis because installation services related to these arrangements and the software related to these arrangements are considered essential to the functionality of certain of the hardware.

      Percentage-of-completion for services related to our check imaging product arrangements is measured by the total hours incurred to date for each contract compared to the estimated total hours to complete that contract. We record provisions for estimated losses on contracts in the period in which such losses become known. Changes in estimates of sales, costs, and profits are recognized in the period which they are determined using the cumulative catch-up method of accounting. If the software is not essential to the functionality of the hardware, we recognize hardware revenue upon delivery.

 
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

      We maintain an allowance for doubtful accounts for estimated losses resulting from the inability of our clients to make required payments. The amount of our reserve is based on historical experience and our analysis of the accounts receivable balance outstanding. If the financial condition of our clients were to deteriorate, resulting in their inability to make payments, additional allowances may be required which would result in an additional expense in the period that this determination was made. While credit losses have historically been within our expectations and the provisions established, we cannot guarantee that we will continue to experience the same credit loss rates that we have in the past.

 
Stock Compensation

      We apply the intrinsic value recognition and measurement principles of Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees, and related interpretations and comply with the disclosure provisions of statement of SFAS No. 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation, as amended by SFAS No. 148, Accounting for Stock Based Compensation — Transition and Disclosure. Under APB 25, compensation expense is recognized over the vesting period to the extent that the fair market value of the underlying stock on the date of grant exceeds the exercise price of the employee stock option. The calculation of the intrinsic value of a stock award is based on management’s estimate of the fair value of our common stock. Changes in this estimate could have a material impact on stock compensation expense in our financial statements.

 
Software Development Costs

      Software development costs for new software products and additional modules for existing software are expensed as incurred until technological feasibility is established, in accordance with SFAS No. 86, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software to be Sold, Leased or Otherwise Marketed. Technological feasibility is established when a working model of the product has been completed and completeness of the working model and its consistency with the product design has been confirmed by testing. Internal software development costs qualifying for capitalization under SFAS No. 86 have not been significant.

 
Accounting for Purchase Business Combinations

      All of our acquisitions were accounted for as purchase transactions, and the purchase price was allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on the fair value of the acquired company’s then-current assets, purchased technology, property and equipment and liabilities. The excess of the purchase price over the fair value of net assets acquired or net liabilities assumed has been allocated to goodwill. The fair value of amortizable intangibles, primarily consisting of purchased technology, was determined using an estimate of discounted future cash flows related to the technology. Actual future cash flows from purchased technology could differ from estimated future cash flows. The allocation between amortizable intangibles and goodwill impacts future amortization expense in the financial statements.

28


Table of Contents

      We amortize intangibles over their estimated economic lives. While we believe it is unlikely that any significant changes to the useful lives of our tangible and intangible assets will occur in the near term, rapid changes in technology or changes in market conditions could result in revisions to such estimates that could materially affect the carrying value of these assets and our future operating results.

 
Long-Lived Assets, Intangible Assets and Goodwill

      We assess the impairment of identifiable intangibles and long-lived assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable, in accordance with SFAS No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets. Factors we consider important which could trigger an impairment review include the following:

  •  significant underperformance relative to expected historical or projected future operating results,
 
  •  significant changes in the manner of our use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business, and
 
  •  significant negative industry or economic trends.

      We also perform an annual impairment test of goodwill in accordance with SFAS No. 142, Goodwill and Intangible Assets. We assess potential impairment based on a number of factors including past operating results, budgets, economic projections, market trends, product development cycles, and estimated future cash flows. Changes in these assumptions and estimates could cause a material impact on our financial statements.

Acquisitions

      Since June 2000, we have expanded our product offerings and client base through the acquisition of six businesses. The operating results of each business acquired have been, or in the case of the acquisition of Maxxar Corporation, will be included in our financial statements from the respective dates of acquisition.

      On June 16, 2000, we purchased certain assets and liabilities of Global Payment Systems LLC for a purchase price of $836,000, consisting of $635,000 in cash and 21,460 shares of our Series F preferred stock. This acquisition was recorded under the purchase method with the total consideration allocated to the fair value of the assets acquired, including purchased technology of $1.0 million. This acquisition provided us with a web-based cash management system and other products and clients.

      On August 3, 2001, we acquired Sound Software Development, Inc. for a purchase price of $3.0 million, consisting of $1.7 million in cash, 80,472 shares of our Series G preferred stock and 55,496 shares of our common stock. In conjunction with this acquisition, we incurred $113,000 of acquisition related costs. This acquisition was recorded under the purchase method with the total consideration allocated to the fair value of the assets acquired, including purchased technology of $832,000, goodwill of $1.6 million and other intangibles of $196,000. Additionally, we recorded a charge of $447,000 related to in-process research and development. This acquisition expanded our complementary product offering to include loan origination software and expanded our client base.

      On December 14, 2001, we acquired Imagic Corporation for a purchase price of $4.2 million, consisting of $1.8 million in cash and 314,486 shares of our common stock. Our assumed liabilities included a note payable of $748,000 that was subsequently paid in full in January 2002. In conjunction with this acquisition, we incurred $120,000 of acquisition related costs. This acquisition was recorded under the purchase method with the total consideration allocated to the fair value of the assets acquired, including purchased technology of $1.9 million, goodwill of $4.0 million and other intangibles of $80,000. This acquisition expanded our complementary product offering to include check imaging software and services and expanded our client base.

      During 2002, we acquired business operations from HNC Financial Solutions, Inc. On March 29, 2002, we acquired certain intellectual property rights of HNC Financial Solutions, Inc. and assumed the related future software maintenance and support obligations in exchange for a $500,000 promissory note. This note was paid in full in December 2003 with the proceeds from our initial public offering. We concurrently

29


Table of Contents

entered into a license and service agreement with the seller for the HNC Profit Manager software in exchange for $564,000 in cash. In conjunction with this acquisition, we incurred $39,000 of acquisition related costs. This acquisition expanded our complementary product offering to include financial accounting, asset/ liability management and financial planning products, and expanded our client base and product offerings.

      On October 31, 2002, we purchased the intellectual property rights that had been licensed in the March 2002 HNC Financial Solutions transaction, plus accounts receivable and related future software maintenance and support obligations for a $950,000 promissory note. This note was paid in December 2003 with the proceeds from our initial public offering. The combined transaction was recorded under the purchase method with the purchase price allocated to the fair value of the assets acquired, including purchased technology of $1.2 million and goodwill of $772,000. This acquisition expanded our financial product offering to include profitability analysis.

      On July 1, 2003, we acquired substantially all of the assets of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. and assumed certain liabilities and the related future software maintenance and support obligations for consideration of $11.7 million, consisting of $8.0 million in cash, a $1.9 million promissory note and 133,195 shares of our common stock. The 133,195 shares of common stock issued to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. were subject to a put and call agreement, in which Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. had the right to require us to purchase the shares at a price of $13.51 per share, and we had the right to require Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. to sell these shares to us at a price of $13.51 per share. On September 3, 2003, FS Acquisition, Inc., the successor-in-interest to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc., exercised its put right pursuant to this put and call agreement with respect to these shares. On December 2, 2003, we purchased these 133,195 shares at a price of $13.51 per share, or an aggregate of approximately $1.8 million. The note was paid in full in December 2003 with the proceeds from our initial public offering. The acquisition was recorded under the purchase method with the total consideration allocated to the fair value of assets acquired, including purchased technology of $530,000, goodwill of $4.8 million and other intangible assets of $6.7 million. We view this acquisition as an opportunity to increase our core data processing client base among credit unions and to increase the recurring revenue component of our revenues.

      On February 24, 2004, we acquired Maxxar Corporation for a cash price of $6.5 million. In connection with the acquisition, we incurred approximately $175,000 of acquisition related costs. This acquisition is being recorded under the purchase method with the total consideration allocated to the fair value of assets acquired and goodwill. This acquisition expanded our complementary product offerings to include a comprehensive suite of interactive voice information solutions and computer telephony integration products.

30


Table of Contents

Results of Operations

                           
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



(in thousands)
Statement of Operations Data:
                       
Revenues:
                       
 
Software license
  $ 9,971     $ 13,449     $ 21,391  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    17,295       30,896       42,461  
     
     
     
 
 
Total revenues
    27,266       44,345       63,852  
Cost of revenues:
                       
 
Software license
    1,592       3,152       5,341  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    10,084       18,430       23,540  
     
     
     
 
Total cost of revenues
    11,676       21,582       28,881  
Operating expenses:
                       
 
Sales and marketing
    8,771       9,533       10,729  
 
Product development
    7,643       6,223       6,854  
 
General and administrative (includes restricted stock expense and related taxes of $3,444 for the year ended December 31, 2003)
    9,068       10,017       15,888  
 
In-process research and development
    447              
     
     
     
 
 
Total operating expenses
    25,929       25,773       33,471  
Income (loss) from operations
    (10,339 )     (3,010 )     1,500  
Interest income and other, net
    428       145       43  
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss) before income taxes
    (9,911 )     (2,865 )     1,543  
Income tax benefit (provision)
    250       (32 )     (234 )
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss)
  $ (9,661 )   $ (2,897 )   $ 1,309  
     
     
     
 
                           
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



As a Percentage of Revenues:
                       
Revenues:
                       
 
Software license
    36.6 %     30.3 %     33.5 %
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    63.4       69.7       66.5  
     
     
     
 
 
Total revenues
    100.0       100.0       100.0  
Cost of revenues:
                       
 
Software license
    5.8       7.1       8.4  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    37.0       41.6       36.9  
     
     
     
 
Total cost of revenues
    42.8       48.7       45.3  
Operating expenses:
                       
 
Sales and marketing
    32.2       21.5       16.8  
 
Product development
    28.0       14.0       10.7  
 
General and administrative
    33.3       22.6       24.9  
 
In-process research and development
    1.6              
     
     
     
 
 
Total operating expenses
    95.1       58.1       52.4  
Income (loss) from operations
    (37.9 )     (6.8 )     2.3  
Interest income and other, net
    1.6       0.3       0.1  
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss) before income taxes
    (36.3 )     (6.5 )     2.4  
Income tax benefit (provision)
    0.9       (0.1 )     (0.4 )
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss)
    (35.4 )     (6.6 )     2.0  
     
     
     
 

31


Table of Contents

 
Year Ended December 31, 2003 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2002

      Revenues. We generate revenues from licensing the rights to use our software products and certain third-party software products to clients. We also generate revenues from installation, training, maintenance and support services provided to clients, from outsourcing center services and from hardware sales related to our check imaging business. Revenues increased 44.0% from $44.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2002 to $63.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. This increase was attributable primarily to a $6.9 million increase in licensing revenue from our core and complementary products attributable to sales to new clients, cross sales to existing clients and an increase in license fees from BISYS. There was an increase of $6.9 million in our maintenance revenue, $1.7 million of which is from the Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. business and $4.4 million in our outsourcing revenues, $2.5 million of which is from the Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. business. The acquisition of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. on July 1, 2003 contributed an additional $2.7 million to revenues consisting primarily of license, service and hardware revenues for the year ended December 31, 2003. We expect that, due to the amendment of our agreement with BISYS, the proportion of revenues generated from our resellers will increase in the future.

      Cost of Revenues. Cost of revenues includes third party license fees and the direct expenses associated with providing our services such as systems operations, customer support, installations, professional services and other related expenses. Cost of revenues increased 33.8% from $21.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2002 to $28.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. The increase was due primarily to a $2.1 million increase in costs associated with maintenance, $1.1 million of which is from the Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. business, and a $1.5 million increase in costs associated with the growth of our outsourcing business, $1.2 million of which is from the Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. business. The Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. business contributed an additional $2.0 million of license, service and hardware costs. Cost of revenues represented 48.7% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2002 as opposed to 45.3% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2003. Cost of revenues as a percentage of revenues decreased primarily because our revenues grew at a faster rate than our costs. In addition, we experienced a decrease in sales of low-margin hardware during the period. We expect that, due to the amendment of our agreement with BISYS, our cost of revenues as a percentage of revenues will continue to decrease, as margins generated by revenues from our resellers have historically been higher than those generated by other sources of revenue.

 
Operating Expenses

      Sales and Marketing. Sales and marketing expenses include salaries and commissions paid to sales and marketing personnel and other costs incurred in marketing our products and services. Sales and marketing expenses increased 12.5% from $9.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2002 to $10.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. This increase was due primarily to a incremental $1.0 million increase in sales and marketing expenses from owning the HNC business for a full year and owning Liberty FiTech Systems Inc. for six months in 2003. Sales and marketing expenses represented 21.5% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2002 as opposed to 16.8% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2003. Sales and marketing expenses as a percentage of revenues decreased primarily because we did not increase our sales or marketing expenses significantly, but revenues continued to grow. In the event that we acquire product lines or businesses in the future, we would anticipate that, based on the nature and magnitude of those acquisitions, our sales and marketing expenses would increase more significantly as a result of those acquisitions.

      Product Development. Product development expenses include salaries of personnel in our product development department, consulting fees and other related expenses. Product development expenses increased 10.1% from $6.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2002 to $6.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. This increase was due primarily to a $0.5 million increase in product development expenses from the Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. business. Product development expenses represented 14.0% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2002 as opposed to 10.7% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2003. Product development expenses as a percentage of revenues decreased primarily because our major product lines are largely developed and therefore did not require incremental investment.

32


Table of Contents

      General and Administrative. General and administrative expenses consist of salaries for executive, administrative and financial personnel, consulting expenses and facilities costs such as office leases, insurance and depreciation. General and administrative expenses increased 58.6% from $10.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2002 to $15.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2003. The increase was due primarily to a $3.4 million expense related to the shares of restricted stock issued to certain employees as a result of the initial public offering and $1.2 million of expense from the acquisition of the Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. business. In addition, there was a $0.5 million increase in accounting and legal fees, due primarily to non-recurring expenses associated with preparing for our initial public offering and settling an outstanding litigation matter. General and administrative expenses represented 22.6% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2002 as opposed to 24.9% of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2003. General and administrative expenses as a percentage of revenues increased primarily because of the restricted stock expense mentioned above. In the event that we acquire product lines or businesses in the future, we would anticipate that, based on the nature and magnitude of those acquisitions, our general and administrative expenses would increase more significantly as a result of those acquisitions.

      Interest Income and Other, net. Interest income and other, net, decreased from $145,000 for the year ended December 31, 2002 to $43,000 for the year ended December 31, 2003. This decrease was due primarily to increased interest payments because of the debt incurred as a result of the acquisitions of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. and HNC Financial Solutions, as well as the draw down on our credit facility offset by interest earned on the investment of the proceeds of the initial public offering.

      Income Tax Benefit (Provision). Income tax provision increased 631.3% from $32,000 for the year ended December 31, 2002 to $234,000 for the year ended December 31, 2003. The increase was primarily because of increased profitability resulting in higher state tax expense and deferred federal tax expense related to the tax amortization of goodwill from the Liberty FiTech Systems Inc. acquisition.

 
Year Ended December 31, 2002 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2001

      Revenues. Revenues increased 62.6% from $27.3 million for 2001 to $44.3 million for 2002. The increase in revenues was partly a result of a $4.8 million increase in maintenance revenues due to an increase in the size of our client base, as well as a $2.8 million increase in revenues from our outsourcing center. In addition, we acquired two businesses in 2001, which contributed revenue for the partial year in 2001 and the full year in 2002, and one business in 2002, which contributed revenue for the partial year in 2002. Our acquired businesses accounted for $11.7 million of revenues in 2002 as opposed to $1.9 million of revenues in 2001. This $9.8 million increase represented 57.4% of our total growth in revenues between 2001 and 2002.

      Cost of Revenues. Cost of revenues increased 84.8% from $11.7 million for 2001 to $21.6 million for 2002. The increase was due primarily to a $5.8 million increase in cost of revenues from the companies we acquired in 2002 and 2001. We also incurred an additional $1.5 million in costs in 2002 at our outsourcing center, which did not open until May 2001 and had more clients in 2002 than 2001. Cost of revenues represented 42.8% of revenues for 2001 as opposed to 48.7% of revenues for 2002. Cost of revenues as a percentage of revenues increased primarily due to the acquisition of the Imagic business in December 2001, which is hardware-intensive and has lower gross margins than our other products.

 
Operating Expenses

      Sales and Marketing. Sales and marketing expenses increased 8.7% from $8.8 million for 2001 to $9.5 million for 2002. The increase was due primarily to an increase of $1.5 million in sales and marketing costs from the companies we acquired in 2002 and 2001, a $0.4 million increase in account management team expenses in 2002 partially offset by a $0.6 million reduction in personnel and related costs in our sales and pre-sales department and a $0.5 million reduction in marketing costs. Sales and marketing expenses represented 32.2% of revenues for 2001 as opposed to 21.5% of revenues for 2002. Sales and marketing expenses as a percentage of revenues decreased primarily due to the fact that we did not increase our sales and marketing expenses significantly as revenues continued to grow.

33


Table of Contents

      Product Development. Product development expenses decreased 18.6% from $7.6 million for 2001 to $6.2 million for 2002. The decrease was due primarily to the fact that the $1.0 million annual amortization of our development cost of one of our e-commerce products ended in December 2001. Product development expenses represented 28.0% of revenues for 2001 as opposed to 14.0% of revenues for 2002. Product development expenses as a percentage of revenues decreased primarily because the amortization expense described above ended in 2001 and the development effort for our major products did not require as much investment in 2002 as it did in 2001.

      General and Administrative. General and administrative expenses increased 10.5% from $9.1 million for 2001 to $10.0 million for 2002. This increase was due primarily to a $1.1 million increase in general and administrative expenses associated with the companies we acquired in 2002 and 2001 offset by a $0.6 million decrease in compensation expense related to the elimination of an executive position. General and administrative expenses represented 33.3% of revenues for 2001 as opposed to 22.6% of revenues for 2002. General and administrative expenses as a percentage of revenues decreased primarily because our corporate overhead was sufficient to accommodate the needs of the organization as revenues increased.

      In 2001, we recorded a one-time charge of $447,000 related to in-process research and development acquired as part of the August 3, 2001 acquisition of Sound Software Development Inc. that had not yet reached technological feasibility and had no alternative use. There was no charge for acquired in-process research and development in 2002.

      Interest Income and Other, net. Interest and other income decreased 66.1% from $428,000 in 2001 to $145,000 in 2002. This decrease was due to lower average cash balances and lower interest rates.

      Income Tax Benefit (Provision). Income tax benefit was $250,000 in 2001 due to our research and development tax benefit from the State of Connecticut. Income tax provision was $32,000 in 2002. In 2002, our tax benefits were not sufficient to offset all of our state tax obligations.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

      At December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, we had cash and cash equivalents totaling $11.6 million, $11.4 million and $85.0 million, respectively.

      The following table sets forth the elements of our cash flow statement for the following periods:

                         
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



(in thousands)
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
  $ (3,332 )   $ 2,702     $ 10,069  
Net cash used in investing activities
    (5,606 )     (2,280 )     (17,582 )
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    11,968       (560 )     81,052  
 
Cash from Operating Activities

      Cash used in operations for the year ended December 31, 2001 was attributable to a net loss of $9.7 million, depreciation and amortization and other non-cash items of $3.6 million and a decrease in working capital of $2.8 million primarily due to an increase in payments received from clients in advance of product and service delivery and an improvement in collections of account receivables. Cash provided by operations for the year ended December 31, 2002 was attributable to a net loss of $2.9 million, depreciation and amortization and other non-cash items of $3.2 million and a decrease in working capital of $2.4 million primarily due to an increase in payments received from clients in advance of product and service delivery. Cash provided by operations in the year ended December 31, 2003 was attributable to net income of $1.3 million, depreciation and amortization and other non-cash items, including restricted stock expense of $7.5 million and an increase in working capital of $1.2 million.

34


Table of Contents

 
Cash from Investing Activities

      Cash from investing activities consists primarily of purchases of fixed assets, investments in marketable securities and business acquisitions. Total capital expenditures for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003 were $2.2 million, $1.7 million and $1.5 million, respectively, and were primarily related to the purchase of computer equipment, computer software, software development services, furniture and fixtures and leasehold improvements. We currently have no significant capital spending or purchase commitments, but expect to continue to engage in capital spending in the ordinary course of business. We estimate that our capital expenditures in the year ending December 31, 2004 will be approximately $3.0 million.

      In the year ended December 31, 2003, we purchased $8.1 million in marketable securities.

      Additionally, net cash used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2003 included the $8.0 million used for the acquisition of substantially all the assets of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. Net cash used in investing activities for acquisitions was $3.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2001 and $564,000 for the year ended December 31, 2002.

 
Cash from Financing Activities

      On December 2, 2003, we completed our initial public offering raising proceeds, net of expenses, of $86.4 million. For the year ended December 31, 2001, we obtained $12.0 million in funding, primarily through the issuance of shares of our preferred stock.

      In April 2003, we obtained a credit facility upon which we could draw an aggregate amount of $4.0 million. We had borrowed $1.7 million against the equipment portion of the facility, which was paid in full in December 2003 from the proceeds of the initial public offering. In February 2004, we terminated our credit facility. As of March 31, 2004, we have no outstanding long term debt. For the years ended December 2003, 2002 and 2001 we made total payments of principal of $5.0 million, $748,000 and $91,000 respectively, to repay outstanding long term debt.

      We currently anticipate that our current cash balance and cash flow from operations will be sufficient to meet our presently anticipated capital needs for the next twelve months, but may be insufficient to provide funds necessary for any future acquisitions we may make during that time. To the extent we require additional funds, whether for acquisitions or otherwise, we may seek additional equity or debt financing. Such financing may not be available to us on terms that are acceptable to us, if at all, and any equity financing may be dilutive to our stockholders. To the extent we obtain additional debt financing, our debt service obligations will increase and the relevant debt instruments may, among other things, impose additional restrictions on our operations, require us to comply with additional financial covenants or require us to pledge assets to secure our borrowings.

Off Balance Sheet Arrangements

      We do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements or relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial partnerships, such as entities often referred to as structured finance or special purpose entities, which are typically established for the purpose of facilitating off-balance sheet arrangements or other contractually narrow or limited purposes.

35


Table of Contents

Contractual Obligations as of December 31, 2003

                                         
Payments Due by Period

Less than
Contractual Obligations Total 1 Year 1-3 Years 3-5 Years More than 5 Years






Long-Term Debt
  $     $     $     $     $  
Capital Lease Obligations
    546,000       468,000       78,000              
Operating Leases
    2,284,000       1,365,000       919,000              
     
     
     
     
     
 
Total Contractual Obligations
  $ 2,830,000     $ 1,833,000     $ 997,000     $     $  
     
     
     
     
     
 

Income Taxes

      At December 31, 2003, we had $43.2 million of federal net operating loss carryforwards that begin expiring in 2007 and had $35.8 million of state net operating loss carryforwards that begin to expire in 2004. At December 31, 2003, we had $513,000 of federal research and development credit carryforwards that begin to expire in 2007; $355,000 of state research and development carryforwards with an unlimited carryforward period; and $405,000 of state non-research and development carryforwards that begin expiring in 2004.

      We have determined that it is more likely than not that our deferred tax assets will not be utilized and, accordingly, we have recorded a full valuation allowance against our deferred tax assets. Currently, we charge against income for certain state taxes and federal alternative minimum taxes. If we determine that the deferred tax assets will be utilized and the valuation allowance is reversed, we will report a significant income tax benefit in that period and, for subsequent periods, will record a tax provision against income at the effective statutory rate. However, we do not expect to incur significant tax payments until all anticipated net operating loss carry forwards and research and development tax credits are utilized. The reversal could occur in the next year should we continue to be profitable and sufficient positive evidence exists to support its reversal.

      For the year ended December 31, 2001, we recorded a Connecticut tax benefit of $250,000. The benefit is the result of Connecticut legislation which allowed us to obtain cash refunds from the State of Connecticut for a portion of research and development tax credits in exchange for foregoing the carryforward of these credits into future years.

      As defined in Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code, certain ownership changes limit the annual utilization of federal net operating losses and tax credit carry forwards. We experienced such an ownership change in 1995. This offering will likely result in a second ownership change.

      This limitation of the utilization of federal net operating losses imposed by Section 382 is applied annually and is equal to a published long term exempt rate multiplied by the aggregate fair value of the company immediately prior to the ownership change. This resulting limitation may also be increased by imputed tax deductions of certain intangibles resulting from built-in gains, as defined. We do not believe that the Section 382 limitation with respect to the 1995 ownership change nor the change that might result from this offering will result in the loss of any net operating losses or tax credit carry forwards prior to their expiration. As a result of future issuance of, sales of, and other transactions involving our common stock, we may experience an ownership change in the future, which could cause such federal net operating losses and tax credit carryforwards to be subject to limitation under Section 382.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

      In November 2002, the Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) issued EITF Issue No. 00-21, Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables. This issue addresses revenue recognition for arrangements with multiple deliverables which should be considered as separate units of accounting if the deliverables meet certain criteria as described in EITF 00-21. This issue is effective for revenue arrangements entered into in fiscal periods beginning after June 15, 2003. Early adoption is permitted. The adoption of this standard on July 1, 2003, did not have a material impact on our financial statements.

36


Table of Contents

      In January 2003, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued FASB Interpretation No. 46, Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities. This interpretation addresses the consolidation of business enterprises (variable interest entities) to which the usual condition of consolidation does not apply. This interpretation focuses on financial interests that indicate control. Variable interests may arise from financial instruments, service contracts, nonvoting ownership interests and other arrangements. If an enterprise holds a majority of the variable interests of an entity, it would be considered the primary beneficiary. The primary beneficiary would be required to include assets, liabilities and the results of operations of the variable interest entity in its financial statements. In December 2003, the FASB issued a revision to FIN 46 (“FIN 46R”). FIN 46R defers the effective date of FIN 46 until the scope of the American Institution of Certified Public Accountants’ (“AICPA”) accounting and auditing guide is clarified. We have no interest in an entity which would qualify as a variable interest entity. As a result, the adoption of this standard will not have a material impact on the accompanying financial statements.

      In May 2003, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued SFAS No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and Equity. SFAS No. 150 changes the accounting for certain financial instruments that, under previous guidance, could be classified as equity or “mezzanine” equity, including mandatorily redeemable instruments, by now requiring those instruments to be classified as liabilities in the statement of financial position. Further, SFAS No. 150 requires disclosure regarding the terms of those instruments and settlement alternatives. SFAS No. 150 is effective for all interim periods beginning after June 15, 2003. The adoption of this standard did not have a material impact on our other financial instruments.

      In May 2003, the Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) reached a consensus on EITF Issue No. 03-5, Applicability of AICPA Statement of Position 97-2 to Non-Software Deliverables in an Arrangement Containing More-Than-Incidental Software. This issue addresses revenue recognition for arrangements that include non-software deliverables, such as hardware, that are more than incidental to the products or services as a whole. The consensus indicates that, if the software is not essential to the functionality of the non-software deliverable, the non-software deliverable is excluded from the scope of SOP 97-2. We expect that the impact of applying EITF 03-5 on our gross margin will depend on the timing and magnitude of our hardware sales. Under EITF 03-5, hardware revenue, previously bundled with software and recognized on a percentage of completion basis, may be recognized upon delivery of the hardware. In certain cases, this may result in earlier recognition of revenue than when the revenue was recognized under the previous methodology. However, the completion of the check imaging arrangements are normally not of long duration, so this impact was not material.

      In December 2003, the SEC issued SAB No. 104, “Revenue Recognition.” SAB 104 revises or rescinds portions of the interpretive guidance included in Topic 13 of the codification of Staff Accounting Bulletins in order to make this interpretive guidance consistent with current authoritative accounting and auditing guidance and SEC rules and regulations. It also rescinds the Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements Frequently Asked Questions and Answers document issued in conjunction with Topic 13. Selected portions of that document have been incorporated into Topic 13. The adoption of SAB No. 104 in the fourth quarter of 2003 had no material impact on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

      We transact business with clients almost exclusively in the United States and receive payment for our services and pay our expenses almost exclusively in United States dollars. As a result, our financial results are unlikely to be affected by factors such as changes in foreign currency exchange rates or weak economic conditions in foreign markets.

      Our interest expense is generally not sensitive to changes in the general level of interest rates in the United States, particularly because a substantial majority of our indebtedness is at fixed rates. A 10% increase or decrease in interest rates would not have a material adverse effect on our financial condition.

      We do not hold derivative financial or commodity instruments, nor engage in any foreign currency transactions, and all of our cash and cash equivalents are held on deposit with banks and in highly liquid marketable securities with maturities of three months or less.

37


Table of Contents

BUSINESS

Overview

      Open Solutions Inc. is a provider of software and services that allow financial institutions to compete and service their customers more effectively. We develop, market, license and support an enterprise-wide suite of software and services that performs a financial institution’s data processing and information management functions, including account, transaction, lending, operations, back office, client information and reporting. Our core software and our complementary products access and update real-time data stored in a single relational database, which is designed to deliver strategic benefits to financial institutions. Our software can be operated either by the financial institution internally or on an outsourced basis in one of our outsourcing centers or through an outsourcing center hosted by one of our resellers. We have historically targeted commercial banks and thrifts with assets under $20 billion and all credit unions. Our aggregate revenues increased from approximately $27.3 million in 2001 to approximately $44.3 million in 2002, and were approximately $63.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2003.

      Our complementary products can be licensed to financial institutions separately or as part of our fully-integrated suite. When combined with our core software, these complementary products provide financial institutions with a suite of applications that operate efficiently and take advantage of the architecture of our core solution, limiting the need for software customization or middleware, which is software that allows two applications to interface. Our complementary products, which are fully integrated with our core, include business intelligence, customer relationship management, or CRM, check imaging, interactive voice response, Internet banking and cash management, general ledger and profitability, loan origination and check and item processing functions. We use an open and flexible software architecture to maximize a client’s flexibility with respect to different hardware configurations and third-party software applications that are commonly used by financial institutions, allowing our clients to select our complete suite or third-party products without incurring substantial additional implementation costs. Based on a design that is customer-centric, our software leverages an institution’s customer information through data mining (sorting through data to identify patterns and establish relationships) and collaborative filtering (the creation of recommendations for a customer based on data gathered on similar customers’ actions and preferences) and allows an institution to provide its customers with better service, improve customer retention and identify and pursue potential cross-selling opportunities.

      In contrast to legacy systems, our technologies are fully integrated, open, flexible, customer-centric and efficient, permitting financial institutions to draw on and deliver consistent information quickly. Our technology allows our clients to access information from disparate sources and then analyze and distribute that information for use at the point of customer contact. We believe that our products and services enable our clients to reduce their overall core processing and operational costs and meet their strategic needs more effectively.

38


Table of Contents

(GRAPHIC)

Industry Background

      Financial institutions have historically invested a significant amount of money in information technology systems. Technology research firm IDC estimates that banks, thrifts and credit unions in the United States spent approximately $42 billion on information technology during 2003 and expects spending to grow to over $52 billion by 2007. According to Thomson Financial Inc., a leading provider of industry information, there are approximately 19,460 commercial banks, thrifts and credit unions in the United States, approximately 19,400 of which have an asset base of under $20 billion.

      We believe that these financial institutions, which have traditionally competed on the basis of personalized service, are facing increasing challenges to improve their operating efficiencies. These challenges include the entrance of non-traditional competitors, the compression of margins on traditional products, significant channel proliferation and the convergence of financial products into a single institution. Recent legislation has allowed non-traditional competitors, such as insurance companies and brokerage houses, to enter the market for traditional banking products. Because these competitors are able to subsidize traditional banking products with the revenues of other, higher-profit products, financial institutions have experienced lower margins, increasing the pressure to reduce costs while continuing to offer an increasing array of consumer products and services. At the same time, the cost and complexity of delivering these products and services has increased as the widespread introduction of new technology has forced financial institutions to expand their distribution channels to include ATMs, telephone banking, Internet banking and wireless devices. Legislative changes have also accelerated the ability of financial institutions to offer wider ranges of products and services to their customers. To distinguish themselves from competitors in this more competitive environment, banks and credit unions must accurately define and understand their specific markets, and be able to launch relevant products and services to those markets over tailored delivery channels. These challenges are forcing financial institutions to examine how to conduct their business and service their customers most efficiently.

      Financial institutions have traditionally fulfilled their information technology needs through legacy computer systems, operated either by the institution itself or through an outsourcing center. Legacy systems, which operate in large mainframe or minicomputer environments, are generally highly proprietary, inflexible and costly to operate and maintain. Legacy systems often require financial institutions to purchase a specific vendor’s hardware and software, requiring them to conform evolving business processes and reporting needs

39


Table of Contents

to the architecture of the legacy systems, and preventing them from adopting new technologies or launching new products on a cost-effective and timely basis. Most legacy systems employed by commercial banks are designed primarily to batch process a large number of transactions and create centralized financial records, limiting the ability of these banks to offer their customers real-time transaction processing. On the other hand, most legacy systems employed by credit unions are designed for real-time transaction processing, but they limit the ability to conduct high-volume processing or more traditional commercial banking functions. In addition, legacy systems typically store data in non-relational, or sequentially indexed, files. Because the data is not organized by customer, financial institutions often face challenges extracting information from their legacy systems, which are unable to easily provide real-time, actionable customer data to the individuals within the financial institution servicing customers without additional software.

      We believe that financial institutions today are seeking more integrated, open, flexible, customer-centric and efficient information technology solutions that:

  •  combine high performance, scalability, reliability and security with the advantages associated with relational and highly normalized (which means data is easily accessible and not stored redundantly) technology based on industry standards,
 
  •  deliver new products and services to their customers quickly and efficiently without extensive custom development,
 
  •  integrate easily with other applications used in the enterprise (whether on an in-house or an outsourced basis) without expensive middleware,
 
  •  provide quick and effective access to customer and account data in order to offer better, more customized services, monitor trends and performance and cross-sell services and products,
 
  •  allow real-time access to customer data while preserving the financial institution’s ability to batch process large transactions, and
 
  •  accommodate, in a single application, multiple delivery channels, such as ATMs, telephone banking, Internet banking and wireless banking, as well as new delivery channels as they emerge.

      We believe that a technology solution must meet all of these requirements to enable financial institutions to achieve a competitive advantage in their markets through improved customer service, competitive product offerings and lower costs. In addition, financial institutions are required by federal law to evaluate the effectiveness of their information technology systems periodically. This obligation, together with significant upgrades and phase-outs of certain hardware by hardware providers, creates an ongoing need for institutions to evaluate replacement of their information technology systems.

      These requirements can be met by information technology systems based on open, industry-standard operating environments and relational databases. Relational and real-time technology can improve information sharing by providing access at each desktop to critical customer and transaction data and business applications, which is restricted or difficult to access in legacy environments. This technology also enables organizations to streamline business practices and reporting to make faster, more informed decisions. Because this technology is based on an open architecture, it is easily scalable by upgrading the server or linking multiple servers. In addition, this open model offers flexibility in that additional functionality can easily be provided through third-party applications. Furthermore, the costs of maintaining a legacy system, which include the costs of upgrading both legacy system software and hardware, are generally greater over time than the costs associated with newer technology.

Our Solution

      Our core software product is a fully-integrated, open, flexible, customer-centric solution that enables financial institutions to service their customers more efficiently and effectively. Our core software operates in Microsoft, UNIX and Linux environments using an Oracle relational database, supplemented by a suite of complementary software applications, which are fully integrated with our core technology and can also be used with other vendors’ core software. We also offer our clients a comprehensive set of support services.

40


Table of Contents

      The key attributes of our solution are its:

 
Full Integration at the Core Level

  •  Fully-Integrated Information Technology. Our core software supports all of a financial institution’s principal data processing requirements using a single relational database designed as an integral component of the system architecture. Our fully-integrated software suite allows our clients to replace their highly proprietary, inflexible and costly legacy systems, which generally contain many disparate software applications, multiple databases and cumbersome and expensive middleware, with one integrated software application based on a single database architecture.
 
Open Architecture

  •  Compatibility With Varied Non-Proprietary Hardware. Because our core system was designed with an open architecture, our clients can run our software on desktop and server hardware supplied by a wide array of vendors, including Hewlett-Packard Company, IBM Corp., Dell Computer Corporation, Sun Microsystems, Inc. and Unisys Corporation. In contrast, legacy systems often require the financial institution to purchase vendor-specific hardware, a vendor’s core software product and vendor-specific complementary products, each of which must be customized to interface with a decades-old legacy system, imposing significant cost burdens, both in cash outlay and manpower.
 
  •  Software Compatibility. The flexibility and scalability of our core applications permit our clients to incorporate complementary software applications, whether designed by us or by a third party, in a cost-effective manner. Our complementary products, which may be used with either our core software or a third-party system, include profitability, web-based imaging, loan origination, cash management, collections, interactive voice solutions and check and item processing modules that may be purchased as part of a fully-integrated software suite or individually. In addition, our open architecture allows a client to activate a particular software module as its functionality is desired, which provides our clients with the ability to react to their customers’ needs efficiently.
 
  •  Scalability. Although most of our current clients have an asset base under $20 billion, our open architecture is designed to accommodate the needs of larger financial institutions, and to provide our clients the ability to continue to use our solution as they grow. In May and June 2002 we performed a three-week performance test and benchmark of our core software, the results of which demonstrated that our solution can meet the processing requirements of an institution with $40 billion in assets and four million accounts. The scalability of our architecture enables us to manage unexpected increases in clients’ processing volumes as well as support the growth of our clients’ businesses.
 
Flexibility

  •  Client Delivery of New Products and Services. Our software allows our clients to offer new products and services to their customers without reconfiguring their information technology infrastructure. In contrast, modifications required by legacy systems in order to accommodate new financial products can be costly and time-consuming and may require the purchase and maintenance of additional middleware. In addition, our clients can change the way in which they serve their customers — such as converting from a thrift to a commercial bank — without replacing or making major modifications to our software.
 
  •  Direct License or Outsourced Distribution. We can provide our core software to our clients by licensing it directly for use on-site, through our own outsourcing centers or through third-party outsourcing centers. We also provide certain complementary applications at our outsourcing centers, including our business intelligence, cash management, ATM, Internet banking, web-based imaging, collections, interactive voice solutions and check and item processing tools. Our flexibility in distribution method allows our clients to use our core software and other complementary applications in the most cost-effective method to meet their specific operational and competitive requirements.

41


Table of Contents

 
Customer-Centric Architecture

  •  Real-time Customer Information in a Single View. Our core software uses a relational database organized around individual customers, which allows a financial institution to update and view customer information on a real-time basis instead of relying on periodic batch processing. Our clients can provide their customers with real-time information concerning their accounts, as well as create accurate and current management reports. Our software is designed to eliminate potential errors arising from the maintenance of multiple databases and to accommodate high volumes of customer data.
 
  •  Better Relationship Management. Our relationship management software provides a set of business intelligence tools that is fully integrated with and acts as a natural extension of our core software. This allows our clients to eliminate the multiple databases required when layering traditional business intelligence tools onto a legacy core system. Because our suite exploits the strength of our core system that is based on a single, relational database designed around individual customers, a financial institution may easily collect and analyze that data to generate timely and responsive initiatives (such as promotional offers) and deliver those initiatives immediately to the customer as the customer interacts with the financial institution.
 
Efficiency

  •  Cost Savings. We believe that our software reduces the overall cost of a financial institution’s information technology and allows our clients to meet their strategic goals more efficiently. The hardware required by a legacy system is expensive to obtain and costly to keep to current specifications while the pool of expertise with older systems is constantly shrinking. In contrast, our core system can run on hardware provided by many different vendors. Because our core software is fully integrated with our complementary products and supports third-party products, development and implementation costs for an institution’s information systems based on our software are lower than those for an institution which must modify its core software and obtain costly proprietary products for each new function. Our open architecture and flexibility allow our clients to modify their information systems requirements quickly and easily, without incurring the significant costs associated with supporting several disparate software applications. Our single relational database allows our clients to organize their data around individual customers, use our business intelligence tools to analyze and manage that data in the most efficient manner and launch new products and services desired by their customers in a cost-effective manner. In addition, because our software is based on widely adopted technologies, a financial institution using it requires less specialized expertise, which allows the institution to achieve greater operational efficiencies.

Our Strategy

      Our objective is to be the leading supplier of software and services to our targeted market. Our strategy for achieving this objective is to:

  •  Expand Share of Our Historical Market. We believe that our software is particularly well suited for financial institutions which have an asset base of under $20 billion. These financial institutions, which have historically constituted our target market, typically can neither afford, nor do they require, extensive customization in connection with the implementation of a core system. As a result, we believe that these financial institutions are willing to evaluate, and are well positioned to benefit from, our flexible, cost-effective technology. We intend to continue to pursue this market by marketing and selling our core software to new clients seeking to convert from a legacy system.
 
  •  Expand Our Sources of Recurring Revenue. We generate recurring revenue through outsourcing and maintenance services. We currently host applications for approximately 160 financial institutions in our outsourcing centers and intend to continue to enhance this service, which we believe is an attractive solution for many of our targeted clients. Our outsourcing centers serve clients using our core software and clients using one or more of our Internet banking, ATM, cView, check imaging, cash

42


Table of Contents

  management, collections, automated clearing house, or ACH, processing and check and item processing products. In the future, we plan to offer all of our products in our outsourcing centers and continue to market our outsourcing services aggressively. Our outsourcing services provide a source of recurring revenue which can grow as the number of accounts processed for a client increases. We continue to seek to expand our client base through licensing arrangements, which we expect to increase the recurring revenues, such as maintenance, that correspond to those licenses.
 
  •  Expand Our Client Base by Licensing Our Core Software through Third-Party Outsourcing Centers. Approximately 172 financial institutions use our core software application at two third-party outsourcing centers, one operated by BISYS, Inc., a major national outsourcing center, and the other operated by Connecticut On-Line Computer Center, Inc., or COCC, a major regional outsourcing center. A number of financial institutions outsource their core processing systems to third-party outsourcing centers such as these, which typically choose one or more significant core software products to provide their services. We plan to work with our existing resellers to add new clients, and have recently expanded our relationship with BISYS for this purpose. We also plan to supplement these resellers with other national and regional outsourcing centers.
 
  •  Provide Additional Products and Services to Our Installed Client Base. We intend to continue to leverage our installed client base by expanding the range of complementary products and services available to our current clients, through both the internal development of new products and services and through acquisitions. In addition, each client has an account manager who recommends complementary products suitable for the client’s business and works with our sales group to generate sales. We also intend to continue selling our complementary products to financial institutions that use core systems sold by third parties.
 
  •  Maintain Technological Leadership. We believe that the uniqueness of the open, flexible architecture of our system provides us with competitive advantages over companies offering other core processing systems. For example, our core software suite can satisfy the technological requirements of a commercial bank, thrift or credit union without modification or customization. We recently announced the commercial release of our web-based business intelligence suite, which allows a financial institution to transmit action messages and collect response information instantaneously while a customer conducts a transaction. Our open architecture enables us to utilize leading, non-proprietary software and hardware to provide comprehensive functionality. We intend to extend our technological leadership by continuing to add new applications, integrate new technologies and expand the functionality of our system.
 
  •  Extend Target Markets. Our primary market currently consists of small to mid-size commercial banks and thrifts and all credit unions, located in the United States. We believe that our core software has benefits beyond this market, and can scale to meet the operating requirements of any financial institution. We continue to explore additional ways to extend our target markets, including by selling our products and services to larger financial institutions and international financial institutions. We also plan to market and sell our products and services to clients in the payroll services, insurance and brokerage industries.

43


Table of Contents

  •  Pursue Strategic Acquisitions. To complement and accelerate our internal growth, we continue to explore acquisitions of businesses and products that will complement our existing products and services as well as expand our client base. Since 2000, we have completed the following acquisitions:
         
Date Seller Products and Services



June 2000
  Global Payment Systems LLC   Web-based cash management system
August 2001
  Sound Software Development, Inc.   Loan and mortgage origination product
December 2001
  Imagic Corporation   Check imaging product
March and October 2002
  HNC Financial Solutions, Inc. and HNC Software, Inc.   General ledger, profitability and other financial products
July 2003
  Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc.   Core processing software for credit unions
February 2004
  Maxxar Corporation   Interactive voice response, contact center management and voice over IP

Technology

      We design our software to integrate with other products, to allow individual customer data to be easily accessible at all times, and to be able to deliver strategic benefits to financial institutions at a lower cost. We released our initial product in 1995, at a time when technical advancements such as distributed computing, browser-based applications and standards for integrating disparate applications were becoming commonly adopted in the marketplace. To take advantage of these technical developments, we created an open product architecture to maximize a client’s flexibility with respect to both hardware options and integration with other software applications. In addition, we sought to design a single platform that could service all financial institutions, including commercial banks, thrifts and credit unions. We also understood the difficulties financial institutions face in retrieving timely, accurate information with respect to their customers, and therefore designed our software with a single relational database as its integral component, placing an emphasis on access to customer information rather than account data. By creating a core processing solution that is open and customer-centric, we believe we have minimized the need for financial institutions to purchase costly middleware and additional databases to perform the tasks that our products achieve with only one software application and a single database.

      Our core software application offers the following benefits:

  •  an open architecture that permits full integration with third-party hardware and software and emerging technologies,
 
  •  flexible functionality, scalability and high performance, and
 
  •  a highly relational database designed around customer information.

      We believe that our software provides these benefits through an open architecture that utilizes a relational database, as well as leading graphical user interfaces and report generation tools. Our software operates in an open systems environment, does not require any proprietary hardware components and is currently deployed on a wide range of client and server platforms. Our open architecture also permits our software to interface with a broad range of third-party applications and peripherals that are commonly used in banks and credit unions.

      We implement our flexible solution through application modules, each of which performs a specific core processing function. All of our modules share and are able to access the data in a single relational database, allowing for consistency of data throughout our product suite. Through database normalization, data is organized in tables that are easily accessible through a variety of query tools as well as through the application modules. In contrast to legacy systems, our architecture allows a financial institution to capture an unlimited amount of data regarding each of its customers without requiring additional software or support. As a result, a higher degree of independence between a client’s business processes and underlying data is

44


Table of Contents

achieved and the solution is more scalable and adaptable to changing business needs. New application modules may be developed or existing modules may be altered as required without having to change the underlying data model.

      Our software utilizes a single, enterprise-wide database, as opposed to a distributed database in which data is spread among two or more components, typically resident on different computers. The principal benefit of an architecture using a single enterprise-wide database is that it permits real-time processing so that, for example, transactions are immediately reflected in a bank or credit union customer’s account. This contrasts with a batch processing approach in which all accounts are updated only at scheduled intervals, typically at the end of the business day. Our software may be configured to operate in either batch mode or a hybrid batch/real-time mode for those banks or credit unions that do not require or desire real-time processing.

Products and Services

      We offer core software as well as several complementary products that may be purchased with our core solution or separately. The open and flexible architecture of our core solution is designed to provide our clients with the maximum array of options for complementary applications. While all of our products function independently of each other, financial institutions which use our entire software suite benefit from our fully-integrated platform and the ability to obtain comprehensive real-time information on all of their customers.

     Core Software

      The Complete Banking Solution and The Complete Credit Union Solution. We market our core software in two versions, one directed primarily at commercial banks and thrifts and the other directed primarily at credit unions. The Complete Banking Solution and The Complete Credit Union Solution share a common software platform that provides a comprehensive real-time open architecture system capable of managing all of a financial institution’s core processing requirements. Our core software permits the financial institution and its customers to view their transactions immediately, whether the transactions occur over the telephone, on the Internet, at the ATM, inside the financial institution or at an external debit location.

      We believe that our core software is less expensive to install and maintain than most legacy systems. It can be easily integrated with third party applications or our own complementary products to provide a comprehensive solution that can immediately retrieve valuable customer information for specifically targeting customers with cross-selling or up-selling opportunities.

      Some of the key features of our core software include:

  •  customer-centric system,
 
  •  real-time customer touch-point integration,
 
  •  integrated real-time and/or batch processing,
 
  •  comprehensive lending and deposit processing,
 
  •  forms integration (including signature and photo storage),
 
  •  customizable web-based reporting,
 
  •  comprehensive teller/ customer service applications,
 
  •  commercial institution functionality,
 
  •  institution and branch operations,
 
  •  direct payroll processing, and
 
  •  product delivery manager.

45


Table of Contents

      The features of our core software offer a comprehensive real-time view of each customer relationship, which enables our clients to provide better customer service by having a complete customer profile available to tellers and officers instantaneously.

 
Complementary Products

      To enhance our core software, we offer a number of complementary products. All of our complementary products are designed to run on any core processing system. However, when used with our core solution, our complementary products are designed to take advantage of the availability of real-time customer information. These products provide functionality beyond that in any core solution, and include:

      cView. cView is an advanced business-intelligence suite designed around two key functional areas: real-time customer contact and knowledge management. cView permits a financial institution to leverage relational technology, customer account and transaction data and instant messaging to gather, convert and analyze disparate customer information into knowledge that can be applied to support timely and responsive initiatives such as promotional offers and make them available immediately through front-line delivery channels, such as Internet banking, tellers and others. cView is designed to operate on any core processing system, whether designed by us or by a third party. The cView suite consists of the following web-based components:

  •  Dynamic Messaging Manager. Application that allows the financial institution to set rules that define the real-time distribution and receipt of customer-related messages throughout the organization.
 
  •  Activity Manager. Application that allows the financial institution to track and manage the activities of its customers and prospects.
 
  •  My Vision. Access point for cView applications, intranet communications and access to relevant documents, messages and Internet links.
 
  •  Report Wizard. Query and report writing tool, which allows users to simplify views of complex database table design, effectively collapsing multiple tables into one.
 
  •  Market Vision. Customer data warehouse designed to permit financial institutions to learn about their customers, prospects, products and business lines so they can make sound business decisions and create effective marketing plans.

      Each component of the cView suite is integrated with the other components, as well as with our core software, allowing clients to focus on the implementation of CRM strategies rather than the support and maintenance of separate software applications.

      Channel Management Center. Channel Management Center is a suite of applications and services designed to facilitate the building and processing of interfaces between disparate systems. Channel Management Center is designed to act as a translator between core, business and delivery systems and to centralize the collection and movement of information throughout the financial institution, eliminating the need for multiple types of middleware services.

      eCommerce Banker — Consumer and eCommerce Banker — Business. Our eCommerce Banker suite provides clients with Internet banking and cash management tools for commercial and retail customers. The modules permit a financial institution to choose from a wide menu of financial services that may be provided to either individuals or businesses, including:

  •  Account Information. Customers can view balance information for checking and savings accounts, certificates of deposit, lines of credit, automobile loans and mortgage loans. Customers can also view year-to-date interest accrued or paid, interest rates and deposit maturity dates.
 
  •  Cash Management. Business customers can monitor their accounts, make tax payments and execute automated clearing house or wire transfers. We also provide a cash concentration function, which periodically sweeps cash from several accounts into a single interest-bearing account.

46


Table of Contents

  •  Funds Transfer. Customers can transfer funds among accounts and establish real-time electronic bill payment.
 
  •  Compatibility with Personal Financial Management Software. Popular personal financial management software, such as Intuit Quicken® and Microsoft Money®, can be automatically synchronized with recent transactions.
 
  •  Bill Payment. Customers can pay bills electronically 24 hours a day, seven days a week and can establish future and recurring payments.
 
  •  Secure Messaging. Customers can communicate with a financial institution through secure encrypted message systems.
 
  •  Additional Features. Customers can reorder paper checks, request an account statement or contact financial institution personnel by e-mail.

      Our Internet banking application supports the open financial exchange, or OFX standard, which enables the system to interface to financial institution services that use a variety of devices to originate customer transactions. These administrative components include the ability for financial institutions’ customers and potential customers to submit account applications in a secure environment. Also, financial institutions can automatically generate e-mail responses to customer applications, update product interest rates and terms and receive customer-specific marketing and data analysis.

      Check Imaging. This software application enables our clients to create and store digital check images for inclusion in monthly statements and to facilitate their customer support services. This product suite includes item/ image capture, document imaging/ computer output to laser disc, or COLD, signature verification, electronic statements, full-service check and item processing and managed services. This product is designed to comply with federal legislation known as The Check Clearing For The 21st Century Act, commonly known as Check 21, and to be compatible with the Federal Reserve’s FedImage Platform. These features are important because when financial institutions exchange checks electronically rather than physically as the legislation will require, they will need Check 21 compliant solutions. The product is also designed to be web-enabled, to eliminate a large portion of entry keying, and together with remote branch capture, to assist our clients in centralizing electronic image storage. Our clients can choose to purchase these products on an in-house, serviced or managed services basis.

      Loan Origination. Our loan origination technologies are designed to provide full-service loan origination processing. Because no two lenders transact business in exactly the same manner, our loan origination products can also be adapted to suit a financial institution’s specific needs. Our software suite provides integrated systems for mortgage, consumer and commercial lending:

  •  The Sound Mortgage Management System provides comprehensive mortgage lending management. This product automates the mortgage process, including advanced disclosures, prequalification, origination, document preparation, processing, loan tracking, underwriting, commitment, closing, full management and government reporting. The system automatically books loans to our clients’ in-house or outsourced servicing systems. The system can be wide-area network enabled throughout all branches, and also provides for remote origination using the Internet.
 
  •  The Sound Consumer Loan Management System provides consumer loan management through a comprehensive set of features, including full document preparation, loan processing, tracking, underwriting, reporting and government reporting requirements as well as an automated decision service.
 
  •  The Sound Commercial Loan Documenter provides commercial loan management from the creation of commitment/ proposal letters to the final production and tracking of complete document packages for any small-business to middle-market loan, including commercial and industrial, or C&I, commercial real estate and construction and Small Business Administration loans.

47


Table of Contents

      Financial Products. Our financial accounting software suite is designed to provide fully-integrated back-office financial management technology to financial institutions, including general ledger, accounts payable and fixed assets. In addition, we offer strategic financial management tools such as asset/ liability management, profitability and financial planning:

  •  Financial Accounting Platform. Our financial accounting platform is an integrated and comprehensive financial management suite. With detailed reporting and responsive service, it helps clients streamline accounting operations and improve the quality of their financial management. The financial accounting platform is comprised of four modules: general ledger, investment management, accounts payable and fixed assets accounting. Each system can operate as a stand-alone product or as part of the integrated financial accounting platform. As a whole or on a stand-alone basis, the open architecture and standardized file specifications are designed to allow integration with other accounting and information management software applications.
 
  •  Asset/ Liability Management and Financial Planning System. Our asset/ liability management and financial planning system provides analytical, budgeting and strategic planning software to enable financial institutions to better comprehend the factors driving their profitability. This software is designed to provide a financial institution with the ability to analyze the institution’s balance sheet in order to determine market value and risk, helping to ensure preservation of capital.
 
  •  ProfitVision. ProfitVision analyzes profitability at any level of the organization. It is designed to generate profit results and value indicators that reveal the contributors to an institution’s bottom line. It can also be used to segment and profile valuable customers and determine which products, business units and channels are top performers.

      Interactive Voice Solutions. Our interactive voice solutions, which we obtained through the acquisition of Maxxar Corporation on February 24, 2004, are designed to provide financial institutions with products that enhance productivity, strengthen customer services and reduce overall operational costs.

  •  Interactive Voice Response. Our interactive voice response solution provides a financial institution’s customers with 24-hour access to their financial information and the ability to complete account transactions such as transferring funds, applying for loans and accessing information about products and services. The product supports both touch-tone keypad response or natural language speech recognition.
 
  •  Contact Center Management. Our contact center management solution is comprised of an enhanced Automatic Call Distributor (ACD) designed to provide sophisticated routing of telephone contacts and other forms of electronic media and agent workflow software used to manage a broad range of client services and marketing needs of a financial institution.
 
  •  Voice Over IP. Our voice over IP product provides a financial institution with a reliable and economical voice communication solution to meet the needs of a multi-site organization.
 
Outsourcing Services

      We have the capability to host a client’s data processing functions at our outsourcing centers, giving the client the benefit of our products and services without having to maintain personnel to develop, update and run these systems and without having to make large initial expenditures. Our outsourcing centers currently host applications for 160 financial institutions, including clients who use our core software and clients who use one or more of our Internet banking, ATM, cView, check imaging, cash management, collections, ACH processing and check and item processing products.

 
Training, Maintenance and Support Services

      Installation and Training. We provide comprehensive installation and training services in connection with the purchase of in-house systems and for new outsourcing center clients. The complete installation process of a core system typically includes planning, design, data conversion and testing.

48


Table of Contents

      Both in connection with installation of new systems and on an ongoing basis, our clients need, and we provide, extensive training services and programs related to our products and services. Training can be provided in our training centers, at meetings and conferences or onsite at our clients’ locations, and can be customized to meet our clients’ requirements. The large majority of our clients acquire additional training services, both to improve their employees’ proficiency and productivity and to make full use of the functionality of our systems.

      Professional Services. Our professional service organization provides services on a contract basis such as operational reviews, which leverage the best practices of our clients to improve operational efficiency and effectiveness across our entire client base.

      Support Services. We provide immediate telephone response service during normal working hours and on-call support 24 hours a day, seven days a week for all components of our solution. In addition, we offer remote product support services whereby our support team directly connects in a secure environment to our client’s server to troubleshoot or perform routine maintenance.

Clients

      We serve financial institutions of all sizes, however, the majority of our clients are commercial banks and thrifts with under $20 billion of assets and credit unions of all sizes. The majority of our clients are located in the United States, although we also have clients in several foreign countries. As of December 31, 2003, approximately 1,300 financial institutions were using one or more of our products. No client accounted for more than 10% of our revenues in the fiscal years ended December 31, 2002 or 2003.

Sales and Marketing

      We have established a multi-channel distribution and sales network. We sell and license our products directly to end-users through our direct sales force and indirectly through resellers, including third-party outsourcing centers. In addition, we support our direct and indirect sales efforts through strategic marketing relationships and public relations programs, trade shows and other marketing activities. We operate primarily in one geographical area, the United States.

 
Direct Sales

      We market our products primarily through a direct sales force which is split between our sales personnel who sell our core software and those who sell our complementary products. As of March 31, 2004, our direct sales force was comprised of 27 salespersons, 12 of which were selling our core software, and 15 of which were selling our complementary products. In addition, our sales group is complemented by application specialists, all of whom have extensive experience in banking technology and provide pre-sales support to potential clients on product information and deployment capabilities. Each client is also assigned an account manager who is that client’s primary contact at Open Solutions, recommends complementary products suitable for that client’s business and works with our sales group to generate sales.

      In December 2003, we split our sales group for core software into two distinct areas of focus; one for the banking industry and one for the credit union industry. We believe that this distinction will facilitate the ongoing effort to design, develop and build better technology products aimed at the specific needs of the banking and credit union industries.

 
Indirect Sales

      We supplement our direct sales force with a range of resellers who sell our core and complementary products in conjunction with their own products and services. These resellers include a range of hardware and software vendors and permit us to better address specific geographical markets, including those outside the United States, and potential clients reliant on existing third-party core solutions.

      Historically, a significant portion of financial institutions have chosen to satisfy their information technology needs through third-party outsourcing centers. In addition to our own technology outsourcing

49


Table of Contents

centers, we have entered into software license and marketing agreements with BISYS and COCC. Under our agreements with these strategic marketing partners, we receive license fees based on the asset size of the financial institution using our applications. We have recently expanded our relationship with BISYS. BISYS has the right to provide outsourcing services using our The Complete Banking Solution software to banks in the United States. Under the amended agreement, BISYS has also agreed to pay us minimum license fees and must achieve minimum sales requirements, as well as pay us annual maintenance fees for each of their clients that uses one or more of our products or services. In exchange, we have agreed not to compete with BISYS for the provision of outsourcing services to banks in the United States through September 2005 and thereafter (so long as BISYS continues to pay us the required minimum fees and meet the required minimum sales) and we have agreed not to enter into similar reseller agreements with any one of six named competitors of BISYS before March 1, 2005. Our agreement with COCC provides it with the right to provide services using our The Complete Banking Solution software to banks in ten states, primarily in the northeastern and mid-Atlantic United States. In February 2004, we entered into an agreement with COCC which provides for the license and resale of our e-Commerce Banker suite of electronic banking and cash management products operated from their data center. During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, BISYS represented approximately $5.8 million, or 9.1%, of our total revenues, and COCC represented approximately $1.5 million, or 2.4%, of our total revenues. During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2002, BISYS represented approximately $2.9 million, or 6.5%, of our total revenues, and COCC represented approximately $1.3 million, or 2.9%, of our total revenues.
 
Marketing

      Our marketing program includes:

  •  direct mail,
 
  •  telemarketing,
 
  •  hosting an annual client conference,
 
  •  advertising in banking and credit union trade journals and periodicals,
 
  •  publishing articles and editorials,
 
  •  speaking engagements, and
 
  •  participating in seminars and trade shows.

Product Development

      We plan to continue to invest significant resources to maintain and enhance our current product and service offerings, and are continually developing new products that complement these offerings. For the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, product development expenses were $7.6 million, $6.2 million and $6.8 million, respectively. We have historically released two upgrades of existing products each year, and, since the beginning of fiscal year 2002, we have introduced a collections system, a safe deposit box system, a web-based business intelligence suite, a web-based imaging system and tools to facilitate the building and processing of interfaces between disparate systems, as well as several smaller modules. The collections system and safe deposit box system were market-driven additions to our core software suite. The business intelligence, web-based imaging systems and the interface tools were designed to exploit the uniqueness of our core architecture, but as with all of our complementary products, they work with other core solutions. We have several new products under development and plan to sell them to both our existing client base and new clients. Our clients also regularly advise us of new products and functionalities that they desire, which we take into account with respect to planning our research and development operations. As of March 31, 2004, we employed a staff of 84 development employees.

50


Table of Contents

Competition

      The financial services software market is intensely competitive and subject to technological change. Competitors vary in size and in the scope and breadth of products and services offered. We encounter competition in the United States from a number of companies including Fiserv, Inc., Jack Henry & Associates, Inc., Fidelity National Financial Corporation and John H. Harland Company. We also compete against a number of smaller, regional competitors, as well as vendors of products that compete with one or more of our complementary products. Many of our current competitors have longer operating histories, larger client bases and greater financial resources than we do. In general, we compete on the basis of product architecture and functionality, service and support, including the range and quality of technical support, installation and training services, and product pricing in relation to performance and support.

Intellectual Property and Other Proprietary Rights

      We rely primarily on a combination of copyright and trademark laws, trade secrets, confidentiality procedures and contractual provisions to protect our proprietary rights. We seek to protect our software, documentation and other written materials under trade secret and copyright laws, which afford only limited protection. Our license agreements contain provisions which limit the number of users, state that title remains with Open Solutions and protect confidentiality. We presently have no patents or patent applications pending.

      Open Solutions Inc., The Complete Banking Solution and The Complete Credit Union Solution are registered trademarks, and eCommerce Banker and cView are trademarks of ours. Open Solutions Inc. is also a service mark of ours. All other trade names and trademarks referred to in this prospectus are the property of their respective owners.

Employees

      As of March 31, 2004, we had a total of 413 employees. None of our employees is represented by a labor union. We have not experienced any work stoppages and believe that our relations with our employees are good.

Infrastructure and Facilities

      Our communications and network equipment is located in both our corporate headquarters in Glastonbury, Connecticut and our offices in Atlanta, Georgia. We have preventive maintenance and disaster recovery plans, which include periodic equipment, software and disaster recovery testing, data monitoring and maintaining records of system errors. We have 24-hour monitoring and engineering support and emergency communication lines. In the event of an emergency, we have a contingency plan to provide services through a nationally recognized emergency service provider.

      We lease approximately 42,000 square feet of space in Glastonbury, Connecticut. We also lease approximately 4,000 square feet of space in Shelton, Connecticut, approximately 1,100 square feet of space in Simsbury, Connecticut, approximately 6,400 square feet of space in Marietta, Georgia, approximately 25,000 square feet of space in Atlanta, Georgia, approximately 1,800 square feet of space in Utica, New York, approximately 12,200 square feet of space in Wixom, Michigan and approximately 1,502 square feet of space in Mississauga, Ontario. Our Glastonbury, Simsbury and Shelton leases expire in 2005 and our Marietta, Wixom, Mississauga and Utica leases expire in 2004. We believe our current facilities are sufficient to meet our needs through the fiscal year ending December 31, 2004, and we will either renew the leases with respect to our current facilities or move to new facilities at the expiration of the current lease terms.

Legal Proceedings

      We are from time to time a party to legal proceedings which arise in the normal course of business. We are not currently involved in any material litigation, the outcome of which would, in management’s judgment based on information currently available, have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition, nor is management aware of any such litigation threatened against us.

51


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT

Executive Officers, Directors and Key Employees

      Our executive officers, key employees and directors, their positions and their ages as of March 31, 2004, are as follows:

             
Executive Officers and Directors Age Position



Louis Hernandez, Jr.
    37     Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer
Andrew S. Bennett
    38     Senior Vice President, Operations
Carl D. Blandino
    53     Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary
Gary E. Daniel
    59     Senior Vice President and General Manager, Credit Union Sales
James R. Kern
    43     Senior Vice President and General Manager, Bank Sales
Michael D. Nicastro
    45     Senior Vice President and General Manager, Strategic Solutions Group
Douglas K. Anderson(1)
    54     Director
Douglas C. Carlisle(2)(3)
    47     Director
David Dame(1)(3)
    45     Director
Samuel F. McKay(1)(2)
    64     Director
Carlos P. Naudon
    53     Director
Richard P. Yanak(2)(3)
    68     Director


(1)  Member of the Audit Committee.
 
(2)  Member of the Compensation Committee.
 
(3)  Member of the Nominations Committee.

      Mr. Hernandez has served as Chairman of the Board of Open Solutions since March 2000 and as Chief Executive Officer since November 1999. From January 1998 to November 1999, Mr. Hernandez served as Executive Vice President of RoweCom Inc., an electronic commerce software vendor to the financial services, healthcare and academic markets. Mr. Hernandez served as RoweCom’s Chief Financial Officer between February 1997 and November 1999. Prior to joining RoweCom, Mr. Hernandez served as the Chief Financial Officer and Corporate Secretary for U.S. Medical Instruments, Inc., a high technology medical device company. From 1990 to 1996, Mr. Hernandez worked in the business and advisory services group of Price Waterhouse LLP, an accounting firm.

      Mr. Bennett has served as Senior Vice President of Operations of Open Solutions since June 2001. From December 1999 to May 2001, Mr. Bennett served as a Management Consultant at NexPress Solutions LLC, a Kodak/ Heidelberg joint venture providing digital printing solutions. From October 1997 to December 1999, Mr. Bennett served as Vice President and General Manager of Worldwide Service at Kodak Professional, a provider of imaging solutions. From November 1995 to October 1997, Mr. Bennett held various management positions with NCR Corporation, a provider of information technology solutions to the retail, financial and telecommunications industries, including as Assistant Vice President of Worldwide Multivendor Services and Director of Global Programs.

      Mr. Blandino has served as Senior Vice President of Open Solutions since January 2004 and as Chief Financial Officer since January 2002. Mr. Blandino also served as Vice President from January 2002 to January 2004. From February 2000 to January 2002, Mr. Blandino served as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Online Resources Corporation, a provider of online banking and bill payment services. From July 1998 to June 1999, Mr. Blandino served as Chief Financial Officer and Senior Vice President of Administration of Segue Software, Inc., an electronic commerce software provider. From February 1997 to March 1998, Mr. Blandino served as Chief Financial Officer of Per-Se Technologies, Inc., a health

52


Table of Contents

care systems integrator and software provider. From September 1992 to January 1997, Mr. Blandino served as the head of bill payment and call center operations for Online Resources Corporation, a provider of online banking and bill payment services. Mr. Blandino also spent over 10 years in public accounting in various management positions with Coopers & Lybrand and Deloitte Haskins & Sells, both international public accounting firms.

      Mr. Daniel has served as Senior Vice President and General Manager, Credit Union Sales of Open Solutions since November 2003 and served as Senior Vice President of Sales and Marketing from March 2001 to November 2003. From June 1989 to March 2001, Mr. Daniel served as Senior Vice President of the Community Banking Group of ALLTEL Information Services, Inc., a software and service provider to the financial services industry. From October 1987 to March 1989, Mr. Daniel served as Executive Vice President of First Operations Resources, Inc. (a subsidiary of M&T Bank), a provider of data processing services for community banks.

      Mr. Kern has served as Senior Vice President and General Manager, Bank Sales of Open Solutions since November 2003. From May 2000 to November 2003, Mr. Kern served as Vice President and General Manager of Syntegra (USA), a subsidiary of British Telecommunications plc, a provider of voice and data integration services to the financial trading market. From October 1995 to May 2000, Mr. Kern served as Regional Vice President of Sales and, subsequently, as Senior Vice President of Sales & Marketing of the Information Services Group of The BISYS Group, Inc., a provider of processing platforms for the financial services industry. From 1985 to 1995, Mr. Kern served in various management and sales roles with companies in the credit union industry.

      Mr. Nicastro has served as General Manager, Strategic Solutions Group of Open Solutions since December 2003 and as Senior Vice President since January 2002. Mr. Nicastro also served as General Manager, Delivery Systems Group from January 2002 to December 2003, as Vice President of Marketing from October 1996 to January 2002, and as Director of Marketing and Customer Services from September 1994 to October 1996. From February 1985 to September 1994, Mr. Nicastro held various product management positions with the Data Services Division of NCR Corporation, a provider of information technology solutions to the retail, financial and telecommunications industries. In addition, Mr. Nicastro served in various positions at Bristol Savings Bank, a Connecticut-based bank, and Citicorp, a bank.

      Mr. Anderson has served as a director of Open Solutions since July 1994 and as Chairman of the Board from December 1997 to March 2000. Mr. Anderson served as Chief Executive Officer of Open Solutions from December 1997 to November 1999 and as President from October 1995 to December 1997. Since April 2004, Mr. Anderson has served as a consultant to New Alliance Bank. From November 1999 to April 2004, Mr. Anderson served as a director and President of the Savings Bank of Manchester, a community bank. From December 1986 to October 1995, Mr. Anderson was also employed by the Savings Bank of Manchester and was responsible for all bank operations and information technology, including as Executive Vice President. Prior to joining the Savings Bank of Manchester, Mr. Anderson was employed for 14 years by Unisys Corporation, an international technology company.

      Mr. Carlisle has served as a director of Open Solutions since March 1994. Since 1982, Mr. Carlisle has served as Managing Director of Menlo Ventures, a venture capital firm that invests in emerging growth technology companies.

      Mr. Dame has served as a director of Open Solutions since March 2000. Since January 1999, Mr. Dame has served as a partner of Key Principal Partners LLC, a venture capital fund. From January 1984 to December 1998, Mr. Dame held various positions at IBM Corp., a multi-national technology company, most recently, Managing Director of Rapid Commercialization.

      Mr. McKay has served as a director of Open Solutions since December 1995. Since April 1994, Mr. McKay has served as Chief Executive Officer of Axiom Venture Advisors, Inc., a venture capital firm. Previously, Mr. McKay was general partner of Connecticut Seed Ventures, L.P., a venture capital firm that invests in start-up companies. Mr. McKay is also a director of Anika Therapeutics, Inc., a medical devices company.

53


Table of Contents

      Mr. Naudon has served as a director of Open Solutions since September 1994, as Managing Director and Acting Chief Executive Officer from March 1995 to October 1995, as Chairman of the Board from October 1995 to December 1997 and as Vice Chairman of the Board from December 1997 to 1998. Since January 1984, Mr. Naudon has served as President of Banking Spectrum, Inc., a banking consulting company. In addition, since April 1984, Mr. Naudon has been a partner at the law firm of Allister & Naudon.

      Mr. Yanak has served as a director of Open Solutions since May 1996. Since October 1996, Mr. Yanak has served as a consultant to NYCE Corporation, an electronic banking services company. From December 1987 to October 1996, Mr. Yanak served as President and Chief Executive Officer of NYCE Corporation.

Board of Directors

      Our board of directors consists of seven directors, which are divided into three classes, each of whose members serve for a staggered three-year term. The board of directors consists of two class I directors, Messrs. Naudon and Yanak, two class II directors, Messrs. Anderson and McKay, and three class III directors, Messrs. Carlisle, Dame and Hernandez. At each annual meeting of stockholders, a class of directors is elected for a three-year term to succeed the directors of the same class whose terms are then expiring. The terms of the class I directors, class II directors and class III directors expire upon the election and qualification of successor directors at the annual meeting of stockholders held during the calendar years 2004, 2005 and 2006, respectively.

      Our amended and restated by-laws provide that the authorized number of directors may be changed only by resolution of the board of directors or by our stockholders. Any additional directorships resulting from an increase in the number of directors will be distributed among the three classes, so that, as nearly as possible, each class will consist of one-third of the total number of directors. This classification of the board of directors may have the effect of delaying or preventing changes in control or management of our company.

      Each executive officer is elected or appointed by, and serves at the discretion of, the board of directors. Each of our executive officers and directors, other than non-employee directors, devotes his full time to our affairs. There are no family relationships among any of our directors or executive officers.

Board Committees

      Our board of directors has designated an audit committee, a compensation committee and a nominations committee. The members of each committee are appointed by our board of directors and serve one-year terms.

      Audit Committee. We established an audit committee in March 2000. The audit committee reviews with our independent auditors the scope and timing of the auditors’ services, the auditors’ report on our financial statements following completion of the auditors’ audit, and our internal accounting and financial control policies and procedures. In addition, the audit committee appoints our independent auditors for the ensuing year. The audit committee reports to the board of directors with respect to the selection of our independent auditors, the scope of our annual audits, fees to be paid to the auditors, the performance of our independent auditors, compliance with our accounting and financial policies, and management’s procedures and policies relating to the adequacy of our internal accounting controls. The members of our audit committee are Messrs. Anderson, Dame and McKay.

      Compensation Committee. We also established a compensation committee in March 2000. Our compensation committee is responsible for all policies, procedures and other matters relating to our equity incentive plans, our employee benefit and compensation plans, management development and compensation of our officers. The members of our compensation committee are Messrs. Carlisle, McKay and Yanak.

      Nominations Committee. We established a nominations committee in August 2003. The nominations committee identifies, evaluates and recommends potential board and committee members. The members of our nominations committee are Messrs. Carlisle, Dame and Yanak.

54


Table of Contents

Corporate Governance

      We believe that good corporate governance is important to ensure that Open Solutions is managed for the long-term benefit of its stockholders. We regularly review the corporate governance policies and practices of other public companies, as well as those suggested by various authorities in corporate governance. We have also considered the provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the new rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the new listing standards of the Nasdaq National Market.

      Based on our review, we have taken steps to implement the new rules and listing standards. In particular, we have adopted new charters for our Audit Committee, Compensation Committee and Nominations Committee and adopted a code of business conduct and ethics applicable to all of our directors, officers and employees.

Compensation of Directors

      We reimburse our non-employee directors for reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in attending meetings of the board of directors or any committee of the board of directors. During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, our non-employee directors did not receive separate compensation for services rendered as directors. Beginning in the fiscal year ending December 31, 2004, each of our non-employee directors will receive an annual retainer fee of $4,000, and an additional $2,000 for each committee on which the non-employee director serves. No director who also serves as an employee receives separate compensation for services rendered as a director. We currently have six non-employee directors on our board of directors: Messrs. Anderson, Carlisle, Dame, McKay, Naudon and Yanak.

      During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, we did not grant any stock options to the non-employee members of our board of directors. Beginning in the fiscal year ending December 31, 2004, each of our non-employee directors will be granted, on the date of the annual meeting of stockholders for such year, a stock option to purchase 5,000 shares of our common stock at an exercise price equal to the closing price of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market on the date of grant. One-third of the shares of common stock underlying the stock options will be exercisable one year after the date of grant, and the stock options for the remaining shares vest monthly thereafter over a two-year period.

      Mr. Hernandez did not receive any compensation during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003 for services rendered as a director. Mr. Hernandez’s compensation for service as our chief executive officer is described in “Executive Compensation.”

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

      All decisions regarding the compensation of our executive officers for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003 were made by our compensation committee, consisting of Messrs. Carlisle, McKay and Yanak and Gregory W. Thompson. Mr. Thompson was replaced as a member of the compensation committee by Mr. Yanak when Mr. Thompson resigned from the board on December 2, 2003 in connection with the closing of our initial public offering. None of the current members of our compensation committee has been employed by us. None of our executive officers participated in deliberations of our board of directors or compensation committee concerning executive officer compensation for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003. None of our executive officers has served as a director or member of the compensation committee, or other committee serving an equivalent function, of any other entity.

55


Table of Contents

Executive Compensation

      The following table sets forth the total compensation paid or accrued for the year ended December 31, 2003 for our current chief executive officer and our four other most highly compensated executive officers who earned at least $100,000.

SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE

                                                           
Annual Compensation Long-Term Compensation


Number of
Restricted Securities
Other Annual Stock Awards Underlying All Other
Name and Principal Position Fiscal Year Salary Bonus Compensation (1) Options Compensation








Louis Hernandez, Jr. 
    2003     $ 321,200     $ 260,000     $ 1,446 (2)   $ 984,019       103,448     $ 5,756 (3)
  Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer     2002     $ 311,467     $ 140,000                   120,689     $ 5,707 (4)
Andrew S. Bennett
    2003     $ 190,000     $ 86,000           $ 134,412       55,172     $ 2,000 (5)
  Senior Vice President, Operations     2002     $ 190,000     $ 54,492                   6,896     $ 2,000 (5)
Carl D. Blandino
    2003     $ 180,000     $ 145,000           $ 195,507       34,482     $ 2,000 (5)
  Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer     2002     $ 173,585     $ 62,200     $ 33,231 (6)           110,334     $ 1,736 (5)
Gary E. Daniel
    2003     $ 200,000     $ 121,000           $ 158,850       48,275     $ 2,000 (5)
  Senior Vice President and General Manager, Credit Union Sales     2002     $ 187,500     $ 100,000                   6,896     $ 2,000 (5)
Michael D. Nicastro
    2003     $ 175,000     $ 91,625           $ 100,294       34,482     $ 2,000 (5)
  Senior Vice President, and General Manager, Strategic Solutions Group     2002     $ 171,016     $ 36,369                   6,896     $ 1,860 (5)


(1)  On May 7, 2003, we issued an aggregate of 680,530 shares of common stock to nineteen of our employees pursuant to our 2000 Stock Incentive Plan. Of these shares, 341,022 were issued to Mr. Hernandez, 46,582 were issued to Mr. Bennett, 67,755 were issued to Mr. Blandino, 55,051 were issued to Mr. Daniel and 34,758 were issued to Mr. Nicastro. The shares of common stock issued to each of these individuals were subject to stock restriction agreements and vested at the end of seven years or immediately upon a change in control or initial public offering. These contractual restrictions lapsed upon the completion of our initial public offering. The dollar amount listed assumes a per share price of $2.8855, the fair market value of the common stock as determined by our board of directors on May 7, 2003. Over the remainder of 2003, we adjusted our financial statements to reflect the fair market value of such stock at the time of grant to be $4.814.
 
(2)  Consists of amounts paid by us to reimburse Mr. Hernandez for personal property taxes on the use of a car leased by Open Solutions.
 
(3)  Consists of $1,606 we contributed to Mr. Hernandez’s 401(k) plan and $4,150 we paid for the premiums on a $5,000,000 term life insurance policy of which Mr. Hernandez has selected the beneficiaries.
 
(4)  Consists of $1,557 we contributed to Mr. Hernandez’s 401(k) plan and $4,150 we paid for the premiums on a $5,000,000 term life insurance policy of which Mr. Hernandez has selected the beneficiaries.
 
(5)  Consists of amounts contributed by us to these executive officers’ 401(k) plans.
 
(6)  Consists of reimbursement made to Mr. Blandino for moving expenses.

56


Table of Contents

Stock Options

 
Option Grants in Last Fiscal Year

      The following table sets forth information regarding stock options that we granted under our stock incentive plans in the year ended December 31, 2003 to each of our named executive officers. The exercise price of each option was equal to or greater than the fair market value of our common stock on the date of grant as determined by our board of directors. The potential realizable value is calculated assuming the fair market value of our common stock appreciates at the indicated rate for the entire term of the option and that the option is exercised and sold on the last day of its term at the appreciated price. These gains are based on assumed rates of appreciation compounded annually from the dates the respective options were granted to their expiration date based on our initial public offering price of $17.00. Annual rates of stock price appreciation of 5% and 10% from the initial public offering price is assumed pursuant to the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission. Actual gains, if any, on exercised stock options will depend on the future performance of our common stock. There can be no assurance that the rates of appreciation assumed in this table can be achieved or that the amounts reflected will be received by the individuals.

OPTION GRANTS IN LAST FISCAL YEAR

                                                 
Individual Grants

Potential Realizable Value
Number of Percent of at Assumed Annual Rates
Securities Total Options of Stock Price Appreciation
Underlying Granted to Exercise for Option Term
Options Employees in Price Expiration
Name Granted(1) Fiscal Year(2) (per share) Date 5% 10%







Louis Hernandez, Jr.
    103,448       15.61%     $ 2.8855       5/5/2013     $ 2,566,101     $ 4,262,898  
Andrew S. Bennett
    55,172       8.33%     $ 2.8855       5/5/2013     $ 1,368,581     $ 2,273,534  
Carl D. Blandino
    34,482       5.20%     $ 2.8855       5/5/2013     $ 855,350     $ 1,420,938  
Gary E. Daniel
    48,275       7.28%     $ 2.8855       5/5/2013     $ 1,197,496     $ 1,989,322  
Michael D. Nicastro
    34,482       5.20%     $ 2.8855       5/5/2013     $ 855,350     $ 1,420,938  


(1)  All stock options listed were granted on May 6, 2003. One-fourth of the shares of common stock underlying each of these stock options are exercisable one year after the date of grant, and the stock options vest monthly thereafter over a three-year period.
 
(2)  During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, we granted stock options to purchase an aggregate of 662,704 shares of our common stock to our employees, including our executive officers.
 
Aggregated Option Exercises and Fiscal Year-End Option Values

      The following table contains information concerning stock options to purchase common stock held as of December 31, 2003 by each of our named executive officers. These options were granted under our stock incentive plans.

AGGREGATED OPTION EXERCISES IN LAST FISCAL YEAR AND

FISCAL YEAR-END OPTION VALUES
                                                 
Number of Securities Value of Unexercised
Underlying Unexercised In-The-Money Options
Shares Options at Fiscal Year-End at Fiscal Year-End(1)
Acquired on Value

Name Exercise(#) Realized($) Exercisable Unexercisable Exercisable Unexercisable







Louis Hernandez, Jr. 
                546,123       228,465     $ 6,152,372     $ 2,815,646  
Andrew S. Bennett
                42,743       88,290     $ 442,390     $ 1,154,351  
Carl D. Blandino
                52,873       91,953     $ 547,236     $ 1,102,055  
Gary E. Daniel
                60,199       77,730     $ 623,060     $ 1,014,985  
Michael D. Nicastro
                70,328       53,615     $ 939,377     $ 705,257  

57


Table of Contents


(1)  Value is based on the difference between the closing sale price per share of our common stock on December 31, 2003, the last trading day of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003 ($17.60), and the applicable option exercise price, multiplied by the number of shares subject to the option.

Employment Agreements

      We are party to an employment agreement, dated May 6, 2002, with Louis Hernandez, Jr., our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. Under this agreement, which has a three-year term, we agreed to pay Mr. Hernandez an annual base salary of $321,200 subject to increase at the discretion of our board of directors, and an annual cash bonus of up to 50% of his base salary, based on the achievement of certain performance targets. Our compensation committee determines Mr. Hernandez’ annual cash bonus. The compensation committee bases this determination on a number of factors, including the commercial introduction of new products and services, Mr. Hernandez’ efforts in identifying appropriate product and business acquisition candidates, and our performance compared to our corporate objectives for a given year, specifically with respect to revenues and earnings. In addition, Mr. Hernandez was granted a stock option to purchase 103,448 shares of common stock at an exercise price of $7.25 per share. The agreement also includes a covenant by Mr. Hernandez not to compete with our business or to solicit any of our employees or clients during the 12-month period following his employment termination. The agreement provides for severance pay if his employment terminates without cause or good reason, or following a change of control (as defined in the employment agreement), equal to Mr. Hernandez’s base salary and the full amount of his target bonus. If Mr. Hernandez’s employment terminates following a change of control, in addition to receiving the severance pay described above, any outstanding stock options held by him will become fully vested.

Stock Plans

 
1994 Stock Option Plan

      Our 1994 Stock Option Plan was adopted by our board of directors and approved by our stockholders in March 1994, and amended by our board of directors in March 2000 and August 2003. A maximum of 2,068,965 shares of common stock were issuable. As of March 31, 2004, options to purchase an aggregate of 1,130,011 shares of common stock at a weighted average exercise price of $5.50 per share were outstanding under the plan. We will not grant further options under the 1994 Stock Option Plan.

 
2000 Stock Incentive Plan

      Our 2000 Stock Incentive Plan was adopted by our board of directors and approved by our stockholders in December 2000, and an amendment was adopted by our board of directors in August 2003 and approved by our stockholders in October 2003. A maximum of 4,629,653 shares of common stock are issuable under the plan. This maximum number of 4,629,653 shares increases each January 1 during the term of the plan by an additional number of shares of common stock equal to 5% of the total number of shares of common stock issued and outstanding as of the close of business on the preceding December 31, but in no case may the maximum number of shares issuable under the plan exceed 10,344,827. No participant in this plan may in any year be granted stock options or awards with respect to more than 344,827 shares of common stock. As of March 31, 2004, options to purchase an aggregate of 2,118,067 shares of common stock at a weighted average exercise price of $10.4696 per share were outstanding under the plan. We have also issued 680,530 shares of restricted stock under this plan.

      The 2000 Stock Incentive Plan is administered by the compensation committee of our board of directors, which has the authority to determine which individuals are eligible to receive options or restricted stock awards, the terms of those options or awards, the status of such options as incentive or nonqualified stock options under the federal income tax laws, including the number of shares, exercise or purchase prices and times at which the options become and remain exercisable or restricted stock vests and the time, manner and form of payment upon exercise of an option. The exercise price of non-qualified stock options granted under this plan may not be less than 85% of the fair market value of a share of common stock on the date of grant,

58


Table of Contents

or 100%, in the case of incentive stock options. The options become exercisable at such time or times as are determined by the compensation committee and expire after a specified period that may not exceed ten years.

      Upon the acquisition of 50% or more of our outstanding common stock pursuant to a hostile tender offer, each option granted to an officer of Open Solutions, if it has been outstanding for at least six months, will automatically be canceled in exchange for a cash distribution to the officer based upon the difference between the tender offer price and the exercise price of the option.

      In the event Open Solutions is acquired, vesting of options and restricted stock awards granted under the 2000 Stock Incentive Plan will accelerate to the extent that the options or our repurchase rights with respect to restricted stock awards are not assumed by or assigned to the acquiring entity. The compensation committee also has discretion to provide for accelerated vesting of options and restricted stock awards upon the occurrence of certain changes in control. Accelerated vesting may be conditioned upon subsequent termination of the affected optionee’s service.

      With the consent of an option holder, the compensation committee can cancel that holder’s options and replace them with new options for the same or a different number of shares having an exercise price based upon the fair market value of our common stock on the new grant date.

      Our board of directors may amend or modify the 2000 Stock Incentive Plan at any time subject to the rights of holders of outstanding options. This plan will terminate on December 20, 2010.

 
2003 Stock Incentive Plan

      Our 2003 Stock Incentive Plan was adopted by our board of directors in August 2003 and was approved by our stockholders in October 2003. This plan provides for the grant of incentive stock options, nonqualified stock options and restricted stock and other stock based awards to our employees, officers, directors, consultants and advisors. A maximum of 2,068,965 shares of common stock will be reserved for issuance under this plan. No participant in this plan may in any year be granted stock options or awards with respect to more than 344,827 shares of common stock. No options or other awards have been granted or issued under the plan.

      The 2003 Stock Incentive Plan is administered by our board of directors, or one or more committees or subcommittees appointed by the board of directors, which have the authority to determine which individuals are eligible to receive options or restricted stock awards, the terms of those options or awards, the status of options as incentive or nonqualified stock options under the federal income tax laws, including the number of shares, exercise or purchase prices and times at which the options become and remain exercisable or restricted stock vests and the time, manner and form of payment upon exercise of an option.

      Upon the acquisition of 50% or more of our outstanding common stock pursuant to a hostile tender offer, each option granted to an officer of Open Solutions, if it has been outstanding for at least six months, will automatically be canceled in exchange for a cash distribution to the officer based upon the difference between the tender offer price and the exercise price of the option.

      In the event Open Solutions is acquired or our common stock is exchanged for other consideration, vesting of options granted under the 2003 Stock Incentive Plan will accelerate to the extent that the options are not assumed by or assigned to the acquiring entity, and, with respect to restricted stock awards, our repurchase and other rights will transfer to our successor and will apply to the cash, securities or other property which our common stock was converted into or exchanged for. The board of directors can additionally cause any options or restricted stock awards to become fully vested and exercisable at any other time. With the consent of an option holder, the board of directors can cancel that holder’s options and replace them with new options for the same or a different number of shares having an exercise price based upon the fair market value of our common stock on the new grant date.

      Our board of directors may amend or modify the 2003 Stock Incentive Plan at any time subject to the rights of holders of outstanding options. This plan will terminate in August 2013.

59


Table of Contents

 
2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan

      Our 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan was adopted by our board of directors in August 2003 and was approved by our stockholders in October 2003. The purchase plan authorizes the issuance of up to a total of 1,379,310 shares of our common stock to participating employees.

      All of our employees, including our directors who are employees, meeting the following criteria are eligible to participate in the purchase plan if:

  •  he or she is employed for more than 20 hours per week and for more than five months in a calendar year, and
 
  •  he or she is employed on the first day of the applicable offering period under the purchase plan.

      Employees who would immediately after the grant own 5% or more of the total combined voting power or value of our stock are not eligible to participate in the purchase plan.

      Offerings begin on December 1 and June 1 of each year. Each offering commencement date begins a six-month period during which payroll deductions are made and held for the purchase of our common stock at the end of the purchase plan period. The first offering period under the purchase plan, which will last only five months, commenced on January 1, 2004, and as of March 31, 2004, no shares had been issued under the plan.

      On the first day of a designated payroll deduction period, or offering period, we will grant to each eligible employee who has elected to participate in the purchase plan an option to purchase shares of our common stock. The employee may authorize up to a maximum of 10% of his or her compensation to be deducted by us during the offering period. On the last day of the offering period, the employee is deemed to have exercised the option, at the option exercise price, to the extent of accumulated payroll deductions. Under the terms of the purchase plan, the option exercise price is an amount equal to 85% of the closing price, as defined in the purchase plan, per share of our common stock on either the first day or the last day of the offering period, whichever is lower. In no event may an employee purchase in any one offering period a number of shares which exceeds the number of shares determined by dividing (a) the product of $2,083 and the number of full months in the offering period by (b) the closing price of a share of our common stock on the commencement date of the offering period. Our board of directors may, in its discretion, choose an offering period of 12 months or less for each offering and may choose a different offering period for each offering.

      An employee who is not a participant on the last day of the offering period, whether by voluntary withdrawal, termination of employment for any reason, or death, is not entitled to exercise any option, and the employee’s accumulated payroll deductions will be refunded.

      Because participation in the purchase plan is voluntary, we cannot now determine the number of shares of our common stock that will be purchased by any particular current executive officer, by all current executive officers as a group or by non-executive employees as a group.

60


Table of Contents

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

Series F Preferred Stock Financing

      On March 17, 2000, we issued 2,145,925 shares of Series F preferred stock at $9.32 per share for an aggregate purchase price of $20,000,021 to 27 independent investors and five existing stockholders. The following beneficial owners of 5% of our stock, or beneficial owners associated with one of our current or former directors, purchased Series F preferred stock:

  •  Aetna Life Insurance Company purchased 214,592 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $1,999,997. David M. Clarke, a former director of Open Solutions who resigned on December 2, 2003 in connection with the closing of our initial public offering, is an Investment Manager of Aetna Life Insurance Company.
 
  •  Axiom Venture Partners, L.P. purchased 80,472 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $749,999. Mr. McKay, a director of Open Solutions, is a general partner of Axiom Venture Partners, L.P.
 
  •  Connecticut Innovations, Incorporated purchased 214,592 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $1,999,997. Connecticut Innovations/ Webster LLC, an affiliate of Connecticut Innovations, Incorporated, purchased 214,592 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $1,999,997.
 
  •  HNC Software Inc. purchased 160,944 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $1,499,998. Mr. Thompson, a former director of Open Solutions, is the Vice President of Corporate Development of Fair Isaac Corporation, the successor-in-interest to HNC Software Inc.
 
  •  Key Principal Partners LLC purchased 321,888 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $2,999,996. Mr. Dame, a director of Open Solutions, is a partner of Key Principal Partners LLC.
 
  •  Menlo Ventures VI, L.P. purchased 52,855 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $492,609. Menlo Entrepreneurs Fund VI, L.P., an affiliate of Menlo Ventures VI, L.P., purchased 793 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $7,391. Mr. Carlisle, a director of Open Solutions, is a general partner of MV Management VI, L.P., a general partner of Menlo Ventures VI, L.P. and Menlo Entrepreneurs Fund VI, L.P.

      In connection with this sale of the Series F preferred stock, we entered into an amended and restated investors’ rights agreement. All rights under this agreement terminated upon the closing of our initial public offering, except for the registration rights described in “Description of Capital Stock — Registration Rights.”

      On April 16, 2001, we issued an additional 1,190,986 shares of Series F preferred stock at $9.32 per share for an aggregate purchase price of $11,099,990 to two independent investors and nine existing stockholders. Aetna Life Insurance Company purchased 107,296 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $999,999. Axiom Venture Partners III Limited Partnership, an affiliate of Axiom Venture Partners, L.P., and whose general partner is Mr. McKay, purchased 214,592 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $1,999,997. Connecticut Innovations, Incorporated purchased 64,378 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $600,003. Connecticut Innovations/ Webster LLC purchased 53,648 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $499,999. Key Principal Partners LLC purchased 268,240 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $2,499,997. Menlo Ventures VI, L.P. purchased 52,855 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $492,609. Menlo Entrepreneurs Fund VI, L.P. purchased 793 shares for an aggregate purchase price of $7,391.

BISYS Agreement

      On August 20, 1997, we entered into a Software License and Marketing and Distribution Agreement with BISYS, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of The BISYS Group, Inc. Under the terms of that agreement, BISYS had the right to resell our The Complete Banking Solution software to banks and thrifts.

      Pursuant to the 1997 agreement, BISYS was obligated to pay us a license fee equal to 30% of the then-current license fee payable by a client who licensed software directly from us. With respect to agreements between BISYS and its clients executed prior to August 20, 2000, this fee was due in equal monthly

61


Table of Contents

installments over a period of no more than three years. With respect to agreements between BISYS and its clients executed after August 20, 2000 and prior to January 1, 2002, this fee was due in equal monthly installments over a period of no more than five years. As of January 1, 2002, BISYS was obligated to pay us 50% of this fee upon execution of an agreement with its client and the remaining 50% upon conversion of that client to our software. In addition, BISYS was obligated to pay us an annual maintenance fee for each client using our software, ranging from 5% to 10% of the then-current license fee payable by our clients who licensed software directly from us. We also agreed to recommend BISYS to our clients as a provider of ATM, debit card and imaging services. BISYS was also entitled to nominate a member of our board of directors and had the right to match a bona-fide third-party offer to acquire all the outstanding shares of our capital stock or substantially all of our assets. Although the 1997 agreement originally provided that BISYS would be the exclusive national reseller of our The Complete Banking System software if BISYS met certain minimum sales requirements, BISYS did not meet those requirements and lost these exclusivity rights as of September 2000.

      On September 30, 2003, we amended and restated this agreement. Effective September 1, 2003, BISYS became our non-exclusive reseller to provide data processing services to banks and thrifts in the United States using our The Complete Banking Solution software through BISYS’ outsourcing centers. Under both the 1997 and the 2003 agreements, BISYS offers our The Complete Banking Solution software under its TotalCS label. In addition, BISYS is obligated to offer our complementary products and services (other than check imaging and check and item processing), which will be BISYS’ exclusive offering for such products and services, to those banks and thrifts purchasing TotalCS. The agreement has a term of five years, with an option to renew for another five years by mutual consent or at BISYS’ option. We have also agreed not to enter into a similar reseller agreement with any one of six identified BISYS competitors before March 1, 2005.

      As described above, under the terms of the amended and restated agreement, BISYS now has the additional right to resell our complementary products to banks and thrifts. Pursuant to the amended and restated agreement, BISYS is obligated to pay us a license fee currently equal to 75% of the license fee payable by our clients who license software directly from us, for any resale of our software, including sales that have occurred since January 1, 2003. In addition, BISYS is obligated to pay us an annual maintenance fee for each client using our software currently equal to 12% of the license fee payable by our clients who license software directly from us. Under the amended and restated agreement, BISYS’ rights to nominate a member of our board of directors and to match a bona-fide third-party offer to acquire all the outstanding shares of our capital stock or substantially all of our assets terminated upon the closing of our initial public offering on December 2, 2003.

      Under the terms of the amended and restated agreement, BISYS has agreed to pay us non-refundable minimum license fees and achieve certain minimum sales requirements relating to both unit sales and license fees payable to us, which are described in greater detail below.

      The aggregate minimum license fees which BISYS has agreed to pay us under the amended and restated agreement are approximately $6.0 million in the first year of the agreement (October 1, 2003 to September 30, 2004), approximately $10.9 million in the second year of the agreement (October 1, 2004 to September 30, 2005) and approximately $13.7 million in each year thereafter. These aggregate amounts include minimum annual license fees for sales of our complementary products to new clients of BISYS, which are approximately $200,000 in the aggregate for the first two years of the agreement, increase to approximately $2.6 million in the third year, and remain constant thereafter. BISYS is obligated to pay us these license fees, which increase annually, in quarterly installments. The aggregate minimum sales requirements which BISYS has agreed to achieve are 28 new outsourcing agreements in the first two years of the agreement and 30 in each year thereafter. We believe that the minimum sales requirements and minimum license fees under the amended and restated agreement are comparable to those under the 1997 agreement, with an increase appropriate to the growth of our business since the minimum sales requirements under the 1997 agreement lapsed in September 2000.

      The minimum sales requirements are set on a regional basis with respect to three geographic regions. If, as of September 30, 2005, BISYS has failed to achieve the aggregate minimum sales requirements in any of these regions, we may terminate, for that region only, our limited non-compete and favorable price and pricing term obligations. However, if we terminate such obligations, we will no longer be entitled to receive

62


Table of Contents

minimum license fee payments from BISYS for that region. BISYS also has the right to terminate the minimum payment requirements for a region if, as of September 30, 2005, it has failed to achieve the aggregate minimum sales requirements in that region. However, BISYS will have an obligation to pay us an additional nine months of non-refundable minimum license fees if it exercises this termination right. As of September 30 of each successive year, the same termination rights will apply if BISYS has failed to achieve the minimum sales requirements in a region for the preceding year. However, if BISYS exercises its right to terminate for failure to meet the minimum sales requirements for such year, it will have an obligation to pay us only six months of additional non-refundable minimum license fees. We are currently unable to predict the likelihood of BISYS being able to achieve these minimum sales requirements, due to the fact that the terms of the amended and restated agreement have only been effective since September 1, 2003. However, pursuant to the agreement, BISYS is obligated to use commercially reasonable efforts to convert its clients using its TotalPlus system to our software upon renewal of its agreements with those clients. For this reason, as well as due to the passage of time and improved market conditions, we believe that BISYS is more likely to achieve these minimum sales requirements than under the 1997 agreement.

      Under the amended and restated agreement, we have agreed not to compete with BISYS for the sale of data processing services using our The Complete Banking Solution software on an outsourced basis to banks and thrifts in the United States except to prospective clients that refuse to contract with BISYS or with which BISYS refuses to contract, to BISYS clients that cease working with BISYS, to any of our clients who wish to use our software on an outsourced basis through our outsourcing centers, or to any client using our software on either an in-house or an outsourced basis as of September 1, 2003. We will also not provide any similarly-situated third-party reseller of our The Complete Banking Solution software in the United States with more favorable prices and pricing terms, in the aggregate, than are provided to BISYS under the agreement, and if we do so, we have agreed to provide BISYS with the same pricing terms.

      The only other reseller of our core software is Connecticut On-Line Computer Center, Inc., or COCC. On December 9, 1997 we entered into a License and Marketing Agreement with COCC. Pursuant to this agreement, COCC became our non-exclusive reseller to provide data processing services to banks, thrifts and credit unions in seven states in the northeastern United States using our The Complete Banking Solution software at COCC’s outsourcing center. COCC is obligated to pay us a license fee and an annual maintenance fee for each client to which COCC provides data processing services using our software. On May 15, 2003, we amended our agreement with COCC to expand COCC’s territory to ten states in which it could resell our software. In addition, for all sales by COCC after December 9, 2002, COCC is obligated to pay us a license fee equal to 37.5% of the license fee schedule contained in the agreement (as opposed to 75% of the license fee schedule that BISYS is obligated to pay us under the 2003 BISYS agreement). The agreement provides that COCC will pay us this fee in two payments. In contrast to BISYS, which is obligated to pay us minimum license fees on a quarterly basis and any additional fees due at the end of each quarter, COCC is obligated to pay us twenty-five percent of this fee upon execution of its agreement with a client and the remaining 75% upon the earlier of conversion of the client to our software and 120 calendar days. In addition, COCC is obligated to pay us an annual maintenance fee equal to 16% of the license fee schedule contained in the agreement (as opposed to 12% of the license fee schedule that BISYS is obligated to pay us under the 2003 BISYS agreement).

      William W. Neville, a former member of our board of directors who resigned on December 2, 2003 in connection with the closing of our initial public offering, is Group President, Information Services of The BISYS Group, Inc. For the years ended December 31, 2001, December 31, 2002 and December 31, 2003, our revenues from our relationship with BISYS, Inc. were $1,335,963, $2,918,801 and $5,836,518, respectively. We believe that the amended and restated BISYS agreement is on terms no less favorable than could be obtained from an unaffiliated third party.

HNC Acquisition

      On March 29, 2002, we acquired certain assets and intellectual property rights of HNC Financial Solutions, Inc., a division of HNC Software Inc. (now known as Fair Isaac Corporation), which is an investor in Open Solutions and a selling stockholder in this offering, and assumed certain future software maintenance

63


Table of Contents

and support obligations in exchange for a $500,000 promissory note. The promissory note accrued interest at an annual rate of 6%, and the principal balance was due in full on March 29, 2004. Concurrent with the acquisition, we entered into a license and service agreement under which HNC Financial Solutions, Inc. licensed to us additional software in exchange for $564,000 in cash.

      On October 31, 2002, we purchased from HNC Software Inc. the underlying intellectual property rights to the additional software that had been licensed in the March 2002 transaction, accounts receivable and related future software maintenance and support obligations in exchange for a $950,000 promissory note. The promissory note accrued interest at an annual rate of 4.5%, and the principal balance was due in full on October 31, 2005. A portion of the promissory note was subject to acceleration in the event that a specific former customer of HNC Software Inc. paid us $750,000 or any portion thereof on or before April 30, 2003, in which case, the original principal amount of the promissory note was to be reduced on a dollar-for-dollar basis and any remaining receivable would be assigned back to HNC Software Inc. We received the full $750,000 that was owed to us, and as a result, owed $950,000 to HNC Software Inc. under the promissory note.

      These notes were paid in full in December 2003 with the proceeds of our initial public offering.

      Mr. Thompson, a former director of Open Solutions, is the Vice President of Corporate Development of Fair Isaac Corporation, the successor-in-interest to HNC Software Inc.

General

      We believe that all of the transactions set forth above that were consummated with the parties that may be deemed to be affiliated with Open Solutions were made on terms no less favorable to us than could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties.

      We have a policy that all material transactions between Open Solutions and our officers, directors and other affiliates must:

  •  be approved by a majority of the members of our board of directors,
 
  •  be approved by a majority of the disinterested members of our board of directors, and
 
  •  be on terms no less favorable to Open Solutions than could be obtained from unaffiliated third parties.

64


Table of Contents

PRINCIPAL AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS

      The following table sets forth information regarding beneficial ownership of our common stock as of March 15, 2004, and as adjusted to reflect the sale of the shares of common stock in this offering, by:

  •  each person known by us to beneficially own 5% or more of the outstanding shares of our common stock,
 
  •  the chief executive officer and the other current executive officers listed in the Summary Compensation Table,
 
  •  each of our directors,
 
  •  all of our directors and executive officers as a group, and
 
  •  each of the selling stockholders, which consist of the individuals and entities shown as having shares being offered.

      Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission and generally includes voting or investment power with respect to securities. Unless otherwise indicated, the principal address of each officer and director listed below is c/o Open Solutions Inc., 300 Winding Brook Drive, Glastonbury, Connecticut 06033. We believe that all persons named in the table have sole voting and sole investment power with respect to all shares beneficially owned by them, unless otherwise indicated. All figures include shares of common stock issuable upon the exercise of options exercisable within 60 days of March 15, 2004 and, which are deemed to be outstanding and to be beneficially owned by the person holding those options for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of that person, but are not deemed to be outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of any other person.

      All figures assume no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option.

                                           
Percentage of Shares
Number of Shares Number of Shares Beneficially Owned
Beneficially Beneficially
Owned Before Number of Shares Owned After Before this After this
Name and Address of Beneficial Owner this Offering Being Offered this Offering Offering Offering






5% Stockholders
                                       
Menlo Ventures VI, L.P.(1)
    1,819,028       0       1,819,028       10.66 %     10.07 %
  300 Sand Hill Road
Building 4, Suite 100
Menlo Park, CA 94025
                                       
Connecticut Innovations(2)
    930,393       500,000       430,393       5.45 %     2.38 %
  999 West Street
Rocky Hill, CT 06067
                                       
Axiom Venture Partners(3)
    917,340       469,000       448,340       5.38 %     2.48 %
  City Place II, 17th Floor
Hartford, CT 01603
                                       
Aetna Life Insurance Company(4)
    869,786       434,893       434,893       5.10 %     2.41 %
  151 Farmington Avenue
Hartford, CT 06106
                                       
Directors and Executive Officers
                                       
Louis Hernandez, Jr.(5)
    837,489       238,372       599,117       4.74 %     3.21 %
Andrew S. Bennett(6)
    105,799       29,000       76,799       *       *  
Carl D. Blandino(7)
    118,555       45,569       72,986       *       *  
Gary E. Daniel(8)
    104,100       31,654       72,446       *       *  
Michael D. Nicastro(9)
    104,289       19,986       84,303       *       *  
Douglas K. Anderson(10)
    279,313       140,000       139,313       1.64 %     *  
Douglas C. Carlisle(1)
    1,819,028       0       1,819,028       10.66 %     10.07 %
David Dame(11)
    647,058       550,000       97,058       3.79 %     *  
Samuel F. McKay(3)
    917,340       469,000       448,340       5.38 %     2.48 %
Carlos P. Naudon(12)
    391,102       189,849       201,253       2.29 %     1.11 %

65


Table of Contents

                                           
Percentage of Shares
Number of Shares Number of Shares Beneficially Owned
Beneficially Beneficially
Owned Before Number of Shares Owned After Before this After this
Name and Address of Beneficial Owner this Offering Being Offered this Offering Offering Offering






Richard P. Yanak(13)
    13,793       0       13,793       *       *  
All directors and executive officers as a group (12 persons)(14)
    5,337,866       1,713,430       3,624,436       31.12 %     19.96 %
Other Selling Stockholders
                                       
Fair Isaac Corporation(15)
    691,061       691,061       0       4.05 %     *  
  5935 Cornerstone Court
San Diego, CA 92121
                                       
Key Principal Partners LLC(11)
    647,058       550,000       97,058       3.79 %     *  
  1000 Winter Street, #1400                                        
  Waltham, MA 02451                                        
Banking Spectrum Services, Inc.(16)
    189,849       189,849       0       1.11 %     *  
  57 West 38th Street
New York, NY 10018
                                       
Hernandez Family 2003 Trust(17)
    13,793       13,793       0       *       *  
  c/o Open Solutions Inc.
300 Winding Brook Drive
Glastonbury, CT 06033
                                       


  indicates less than 1%

  (1)  Consists of 1,792,088 shares held by Menlo Ventures VI, L.P. and 26,940 shares held by Menlo Entrepreneurs Fund VI, L.P. MV Management VI, L.P. is a general partner of Menlo Ventures VI, L.P. and Menlo Entrepreneurs Fund VI, L.P. Mr. Carlisle, a director of Open Solutions, H. DuBose Montgomery, John W. Jarve, Thomas H. Bredt, Sonja Hoel and Mark A. Siegel are general partners of MV Management VI, L.P. Messrs. Carlisle, Montgomery, Jarve, Bredt and Siegel and Ms. Hoel each disclaim beneficial ownership of the shares held by Menlo Ventures VI, L.P. and Menlo Entrepreneurs Fund VI, L.P., except to the extent of his or her pecuniary interest therein.
 
  (2)  The Number of Shares Beneficially Owned Before this Offering consists of 672,055 shares held by Connecticut Innovations, Incorporated and 258,338 shares held by Webster Financial Corporation. The Number of Shares Being Offered consists solely of 500,000 shares being offered by Connecticut Innovations, Incorporated. The Number of Shares Beneficially Owned After this Offering consists of 172,055 shares held by Connecticut Innovations, Incorporated and 258,338 shares held by Webster Financial Corporation.
 
  (3)  The Number of Shares Beneficially Owned Before this Offering consists of 682,046 shares held by Axiom Venture Partners, L.P. and 235,294 shares held by Axiom Venture Partners III Limited Partnership. The Number of Shares Being Offered consists of 410,000 shares being offered by Axiom Venture Partners, L.P. and 59,000 shares being offered by Axiom Venture Partners III Limited Partnership. The Number of Shares Beneficially Owned After this Offering consists of 272,046 shares held by Axiom Venture Partners, L.P. and 176,294 shares held by Axiom Venture Partners III Limited Partnership. Mr. McKay, a director of Open Solutions, is a general partner of Axiom Venture Partners, L.P. and Axiom Venture Partners III Limited Partnership. Mr. McKay disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares held by Axiom Venture Partners, L.P. and Axiom Venture Partners III Limited Partnership, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.
 
  (4)  Mr. Clarke, a former director of Open Solutions, is an Investment Manager of Aetna Life Insurance Company.
 
  (5)  The Number of Shares Being Offered includes 13,793 shares being offered by the Hernandez Family 2003 Trust, of which Wendy Hernandez, Mr. Hernandez’s spouse, is a trustee. The Number of Shares Beneficially Owned Before this Offering includes 13,793 shares held by the Hernandez Family 2003 Trust, and both the Number of Shares Beneficially Owned Before this Offering and the Number of Shares Beneficially Owned After this Offering include 5,883 shares held by Wendy Hernandez and

66


Table of Contents

  593,234 shares which Mr. Hernandez has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options. Mr. Hernandez disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares held by the Hernandez Family 2003 Trust, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.
 
  (6)  Includes 59,217 shares which Mr. Bennett has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options.
 
  (7)  Includes 72,986 shares which Mr. Blandino has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options.
 
  (8)  Includes 72,446 shares which Mr. Daniel has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options.
 
  (9)  Includes 84,303 shares which Mr. Nicastro has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options.

(10)  Includes 9,199 shares which Mr. Anderson has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options.
 
(11)  Consists solely of shares held by Key Principal Partners LLC. Mr. Dame, a director of Open Solutions, is a partner of Key Principal Partners LLC. Mr. Dame disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares held by Key Principal Partners LLC, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.
 
(12)  The Number of Shares Being Offered consists solely of 189,849 shares being offered by Banking Spectrum Services, Inc. The Number of Shares Beneficially Owned Before this Offering includes 189,849 shares held by Banking Spectrum Services, Inc., and both the Number of Shares Beneficially Owned Before this Offering and the Number of Shares Beneficially Owned After this Offering include 20,689 shares held by The Enrique S. Naudon Trust, 20,689 shares held by The Ignacio S. Naudon Trust, 13,793 shares held by The Huguette Rivet Trust, 6,251 shares held by The Eric P. Steingass Trust dtd 12/22/97, 10,776 shares held by Allister & Naudon P/S, Raymond James & Associates, Inc. CSDN FBO, Jeffrey W. Allister, 5,883 shares held by Raymond James & Assoc., Inc. Custodian FBO Jeffrey W. Allister PS and 5,883 shares held by Raymond James & Assoc., Inc. Custodian FBO Jeffrey W. Allister MP. Mr. Naudon, a director of Open Solutions, is chief executive officer, a director and the majority shareholder of Banking Spectrum Services, Inc., a trustee of Allister & Naudon P/S, Raymond James & Associates, Inc. CSDN FBO, Jeffrey W. Allister, Raymond James & Assoc., Inc. Custodian FBO Jeffrey W. Allister PS and Raymond James & Assoc., Inc. Custodian FBO Jeffrey W. Allister MP, and Susan Steingass, his spouse, is a trustee of The Enrique S. Naudon Trust, The Ignacio S. Naudon Trust, The Huguette Rivet Trust and The Eric P. Steingass Trust dtd 12/22/97. Mr. Naudon disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares held by The Enrique S. Naudon Trust, The Ignacio S. Naudon Trust, The Huguette Rivet Trust, The Eric P. Steingass Trust dtd 12/22/97, Allister & Naudon P/ S, Raymond James & Associates, Inc. CSDN FBO, Jeffrey W. Allister, Raymond James & Assoc., Inc. Custodian FBO Jeffrey W. Allister PS and Raymond James & Assoc., Inc. Custodian FBO Jeffrey W. Allister MP, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.
 
(13)  Consists solely of 13,793 shares which Mr. Yanak has the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options.
 
(14)  Includes an aggregate of 905,178 shares of common stock which our directors and executive officers have the right to acquire within 60 days after March 15, 2004 upon the exercise of stock options.
 
(15)  Mr. Thompson, a former director of Open Solutions, is Vice President of Corporate Development of Fair Isaac Corporation.
 
(16)  Mr. Naudon, a director of Open Solutions, is chief executive officer, a director and the majority shareholder of Banking Spectrum Services, Inc.
 
(17)  Wendy Hernandez, Mr. Hernandez’s spouse, is a trustee of the Hernandez Family 2003 Trust.

67


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

General

      The following description of our capital stock does not purport to be complete and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, our restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated by-laws, which are filed as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part.

      Our authorized capital stock consists of 95,000,000 shares of common stock, $0.01 par value per share, and 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock, $0.01 par value per share. Immediately following the completion of this offering, an aggregate of 18,084,103 shares of common stock will be issued and outstanding (based on the number of shares of common stock issued and outstanding as of March 31, 2004) and no shares of preferred stock will be issued and outstanding. As of March 31, 2004, there were 93 record holders of our common stock.

Common Stock

      Voting Rights. The holders of our common stock are entitled to one vote for each share held on all matters submitted to a vote of the stockholders, and are not able to multiply the number of shares they own by the number of directors up for election for purposes of electing directors. Accordingly, holders of a majority of the shares of common stock entitled to vote in any election of directors may elect all of the directors standing for election.

      Dividends. The holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends in proportion to the number of shares they hold if dividends are declared by our board of directors out of funds that are legally available for that purpose, provided that dividends declared on outstanding preferred stock shall have priority.

      Other Rights. Upon the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of Open Solutions, the holders of our common stock are entitled to receive the net assets of our available cash after the payment of all debts and other liabilities, provided that holders of the outstanding preferred stock shall have priority. The holders of our common stock have no preferential right to participate in any future debt or equity offerings, to have their shares redeemed or to convert their shares into any other type of security. The outstanding shares of common stock are, and the shares offered by us in this offering will be, when issued and paid for, fully paid and non-assessable. In the event Open Solutions issues shares of preferred stock in the future, the rights of the holders of our common stock may be adversely affected by that issuance because it is probable that any preferred stock issued will have certain rights and preferences that entitle the holders of such shares to have priority over the holders of the common stock with respect to certain matters. These matters include the right to receive dividends and the right to receive our assets in the event of a bankruptcy or other similar event. There will be no shares of preferred stock outstanding immediately after the closing of this offering.

Preferred Stock

      Under our restated certificate of incorporation, our board of directors is authorized, subject to certain limitations prescribed by law, without further stockholder approval from time to time to issue up to an aggregate of 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock. The preferred stock may be issued in one or more series. Each series may have different rights, preferences and designations and qualifications and limitations and restrictions that may be established by our board of directors without approval from the shareholders. The rights, designations and preferences may include:

  •  dividend rights,
 
  •  dividend rates,
 
  •  the right to convert the shares of preferred stock into common stock,
 
  •  voting rights,

68


Table of Contents

  •  the right to set aside a certain amount of assets for payments relating to the preferred shares, and
 
  •  prices to be paid upon redemption of the preferred shares or a bankruptcy or similar event.

      If our board of directors decides to issue any shares of preferred stock, it could have the effect of delaying or preventing another party from taking control of us. This is because the terms of the preferred stock would be designed to make it prohibitively expensive for any unwanted third party to make a bid for the shares of Open Solutions. We have no present plans to issue any shares of preferred stock.

Anti-Takeover Effects of Certain Provisions of Delaware Law and Our Charter and By-Laws

      Effect of Delaware Anti-Takeover Statute. We are subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law. Section 203 prohibits a publicly-held Delaware corporation from engaging in a “business combination” with an “interested stockholder” for a period of three years after the date of the transaction in which the person became an interested stockholder, unless the business combination is approved in a prescribed manner. A “business combination” includes, among other things, mergers, asset sales and other transactions resulting in a financial benefit to the interested stockholder. An “interested stockholder” is a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns (or, in some cases, within three years prior, did own) 15% or more of the corporation’s voting stock, or is an affiliate of the corporation and owned 15% or more of the corporation’s voting stock at any time during the three years prior to the time that the determination of an interested stockholder is made. Under Section 203, a business combination between the corporation and an interested stockholder is prohibited unless it satisfies one of the following conditions:

  •  before the stockholder became interested, the board of directors approved either the business combination or the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, or
 
  •  upon consummation of the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, the interested stockholder owned at least 85% of the voting stock of the corporation outstanding at the time the transaction commenced (excluding, for purposes of determining the number of our shares outstanding, shares owned by (a) persons who are directors and also officers and (b) employee stock plans, in some instances), or
 
  •  after the stockholder became interested, the business combination was approved by the board of directors of the corporation and authorized at an annual or special meeting of the stockholders by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the outstanding voting stock which is not owned by the interested stockholder.

      Charter and By-Law Provisions. Our certificate of incorporation and by-laws include provisions that may have the effect of discouraging, delaying or preventing a change in control or an unsolicited acquisition proposal that a stockholder might consider favorable, including a proposal that might result in the payment of a premium over the market price for the shares held by stockholders. These provisions are summarized in the following paragraphs.

      Board of Directors. Our certificate of incorporation and by-laws provide for the division of the board of directors into three classes, as nearly equal in size as possible, with staggered three-year terms. Approximately one-third of our board will be elected each year. Any director may be removed only for cause by the vote of 75% of the shares that are permitted to vote for the election of directors. Under our by-laws, any vacancy on our board of directors, however occurring, may only be filled by vote of a majority of our directors then in office even if less than a quorum. The classification of our board of directors and the limitations on the removal of directors and filling of vacancies could have the effect of making it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or of discouraging a third party from attempting to acquire, control of us.

      Notice Procedures. Our by-laws provide that for nominations to our board of directors or for other business to be properly brought by a stockholder before an annual meeting of stockholders, the stockholder must first have given timely notice of the matter in writing to our Secretary. To be timely, a notice of

69


Table of Contents

nominations or other business to be brought before an annual meeting must be delivered (i) between 60 and 90 days before the date that is the one year anniversary of the date of the preceding year’s annual meeting; or (ii) if the date of the current year’s annual meeting is more than 20 days before or 60 days after the anniversary date described in (ii), then notice must be given no earlier than 90 days before the meeting and no later than 60 days prior to such meeting or 10 days following the day on which public announcement of such meeting is first made, whichever is later. The notice must contain, among other things, information about the stockholder delivering the notice and, as applicable, background information about each nominee or a description of the proposed business to be brought before the meeting. Our by-laws may have the effect of precluding the consideration of some business at a meeting if the proper procedures are not followed or may discourage or defer a potential acquirer from conducting a solicitation of proxies to elect its own slate of directors or otherwise attempting to obtain control of us.

      No Stockholder Action by Written Consent; Special Meeting of Stockholders. Our certificate of incorporation provides that any action required or permitted to be taken by the stockholders of Open Solutions may be taken only at a duly called annual or special meeting of the stockholders. Special meetings may be called only by the board of directors, the Chairman of the board of directors or the President of Open Solutions. These provisions could have the effect of delaying until the next annual stockholders meeting stockholder actions that are favored by the holders of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of Open Solutions. These provisions may also discourage another person or entity from making an offer to our stockholders for the common stock, because even if the person or entity who makes the offer acquired a majority of our outstanding voting securities, that person or entity would be unable to call a special meeting of the stockholders and would further be unable to obtain unanimous written consent of the stockholders. As a result, any meeting as to matters they endorse, including the election of new directors or the approval of a merger, would have to wait for the next duly called stockholders meeting.

      Supermajority Voting. The Delaware General Corporation Law provides that the affirmative vote of a majority of the shares entitled to vote on any matter is required to amend a corporation’s certificate of incorporation or by-laws, unless the corporation’s certificate of incorporation or by-laws, as the case may be, requires a greater percentage. Our certificate of incorporation requires the affirmative vote of the holders of at least 75% of the outstanding voting stock of Open Solutions to amend or repeal any of the provisions of our certificate of incorporation described above, and the affirmative vote of the holders of at least a majority of the outstanding voting stock to reduce the number of authorized shares of common stock and preferred stock. A 75% vote is also required to amend or repeal any of our by-law provisions described above. The 75% stockholder vote would be in addition to any separate class vote that might in the future be required pursuant to the terms of any series of preferred stock that might be outstanding at the time any of these amendments are submitted to stockholders. Our by-laws may also be amended or repealed by a majority vote of our board of directors.

      Authorized but Unissued or Undesignated Capital Stock. Subject to the limitations prescribed by law, our board of directors has the authority to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of preferred stock and determine the price, rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions, including voting rights, of those shares without any further vote or action by the stockholders. The issuance of preferred stock, while providing flexibility in connection with possible financings or acquisitions or other corporate purposes, could have the effect of making it more difficult for a third party to acquire a majority of our outstanding voting stock.

      Limitation of Director Liability. Our certificate of incorporation limits the liability of our directors (in their capacity as directors, but not in their capacity as officers) to us or our stockholders to the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law. Specifically, our directors will not be personally liable for monetary damages for breach of a director’s fiduciary duty as a director, except for liability:

  •  for any breach of the director’s duty of loyalty to us or our stockholders,
 
  •  for acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of the law,

70


Table of Contents

  •  under Section 174 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, which relates to unlawful payments of dividends or unlawful stock purchases or redemptions, or
 
  •  for any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit.

      Indemnification Arrangements. Our certificate of incorporation provides that our directors and officers shall be indemnified and provides for the advancement to them of expenses in connection with actual or threatened proceedings and claims arising out of their status as a director or officer.

Registration Rights

      On March 17, 2000, we entered into an Amended and Restated Investors’ Rights Agreement with all of the holders of Series A-1 preferred stock, Series A-2 preferred stock, Series B preferred stock, Series C preferred stock, Series D preferred stock and Series E preferred stock, and the holders of 3,336,911 of the 3,358,371 then-outstanding shares of Series F preferred stock. All shares of preferred stock converted into shares of common stock on December 2, 2003, the date of the closing of our initial public offering. A number of the selling stockholders in this offering are parties to the investors’ rights agreement.

      Demand Registrations. The parties to the investors’ rights agreement holding shares of common stock with an anticipated gross offering price of at least $5.0 million may request registration of their shares of common stock. We are obligated to effect only two registrations pursuant to such a request by holders of registration rights. We are not obligated to effect a demand registration under the investors’ rights agreement during the period starting with the date 60 days prior to the filing of, and ending on a date 180 days following effectiveness of, a registration subject to the piggyback registration rights described below.

      Piggyback Registration Rights. The parties to the investors’ rights agreement have unlimited rights to request that their shares be included in any company-initiated registration of common stock other than registrations of employee benefit plans or convertible debt.

      Form S-3 Registrations. After we have qualified for registration on Form S-3, holders of one-third or more of the shares having registration rights under the investors’ rights agreement may request in writing that we effect a registration of their shares on Form S-3, provided that the gross offering price of the shares to be so registered in each such registration exceeds $2.0 million.

      Future Grants of Registration Rights. Without the consent of at least a majority of the then outstanding registrable securities held by parties to the investors’ rights agreement, we may not grant further registration rights which would be on equal or more favorable terms than the registration rights provided for in the investors’ rights agreement.

      Transferability. The registration rights granted under the investors’ rights agreement are transferable upon transfer of the underlying securities and notice by the holder to us of the transfer, provided that the transferee or assignee, after the transfer or assignment, holds at least 68,966 shares eligible for registration and assumes the rights and obligations of the transferor for such shares. The transferee or assignee must also agree in writing to be bound by the terms of the investors’ rights agreement.

      Termination. The registration rights granted under the investors’ rights agreement will terminate on December 2, 2008. In addition, the terms of the investors’ rights agreement may only be amended or waived with the written consent of Open Solutions and holders of a majority of the shares that are subject to the investors’ rights agreement.

Listing

      Our common stock is quoted on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol “OPEN.”

Transfer Agent and Registrar

      The transfer agent and registrar for our common stock is EquiServe Trust Company, N.A.

71


Table of Contents

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

      Prior to November 26, 2003, there was no public market for our common stock, and we cannot predict the effect, if any, that market sales of shares of our common stock or the availability of shares of our common stock for sale will have on the market price of our common stock prevailing from time to time. Nevertheless, sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market could adversely affect the market price of our common stock and could impair our future ability to raise capital through the sale of our equity securities.

      Upon the completion of this offering, we will have 18,084,103 shares of common stock outstanding, based on the number of shares outstanding as of March 31, 2004, and assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option. The number of shares of common stock to be outstanding after this offering is based on the number of shares outstanding as of March 31, 2004, and excludes:

  •  3,248,078 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding options as of March 31, 2004 at a weighted average exercise price of $8.74 per share, and
 
  •  5,249,230 shares of our common stock reserved for issuance under our 1994 Stock Incentive Plan, 2000 Stock Incentive Plan, 2003 Stock Incentive Plan and 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

      Of the outstanding shares, the 3,339,384 shares sold in this offering, any shares issued upon exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option, the 5,750,000 shares sold in our initial public offering in December 2003 and all shares registered on Form S-8 registration statements filed by us will be freely tradable without restriction under the Securities Act, except that any shares held by our “affiliates,” as the term is defined in Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act, may only be sold in compliance with the limitations described below. The remaining shares of common stock will be deemed “restricted securities” as defined under Rule 144. Some of these shares are subject to the lock-up agreements described below. Restricted securities may be sold in the public market only if registered or if they qualify for resale under Rules 144, 144(k) or 701 promulgated under the Securities Act, which rules are summarized below. Of these remaining shares of our common stock:

  •  2,683,111 shares may be sold upon expiration of the 180-day lock-up period entered into with each of our officers and directors and holders of a majority of our common stock in connection with our initial public offering, which expires on May 24, 2004, and is described below, and
 
  •  1,417,331 additional shares may be sold upon the expiration of the 90-day lock-up period entered into in connection with this offering, which is described below.

Rule 144

      In general, under Rule 144, beginning 90 days after the date of a company’s initial public offering, a person who has beneficially owned shares of stock for at least one year is entitled to sell those shares. Persons who have owned shares of our common stock for at least one year are entitled to sell, within any three-month period, a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of:

  •  1% of the number of shares of common stock then outstanding, which will equal approximately 180,841 shares immediately after this offering, or
 
  •  the average weekly trading volume of our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a notice on Form 144 with respect to that sale.

      Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to manner of sale provisions and notice requirements and to the availability of current public information about us.

Rule 144(k)

      Under Rule 144(k), a person who is not deemed to have been one of our “affiliates” at any time during the three months preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned the shares proposed to be sold for at least two years, generally including the holding period of any prior owner other than an “affiliate,” is entitled to

72


Table of Contents

sell such shares without complying with the manner of sale, notice filing, volume limitation or notice provisions of Rule 144.

Rule 701

      In general, under Rule 701, any of our employees, directors, officers, consultants or advisors who purchased shares (or were issued shares) of our common stock from us in connection with a compensatory stock or option plan or other written agreement before our initial public offering is entitled to resell those shares 90 days after our initial public offering in reliance on Rule 144, without having to comply with certain restrictions, including the holding period, contained in Rule 144.

      The SEC has indicated that Rule 701 will apply to typical stock options granted by an issuer before it becomes subject to the reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, along with the shares acquired upon exercise of those stock options, including exercises after the date of our initial public offering. Securities issued in reliance on Rule 701 are restricted securities and, subject to the contractual restrictions described above, beginning three months after the date of our initial public offering, may be sold by persons other than “affiliates” as defined in Rule 144, subject only to the manner of sale provisions of Rule 144. Securities issued in reliance on Rule 701 may be sold by “affiliates” under Rule 144 without compliance with its one year minimum holding period requirement.

Stock Options

      As of March 31, 2004, options to purchase a total of 3,248,078 shares of common stock were outstanding, of which 1,562,370 were exercisable. We have filed Form S-8 registration statements under the Securities Act to register all shares of our common stock issuable under our 1994 Stock Incentive Plan, 2000 Stock Incentive Plan, 2003 Stock Incentive Plan and 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. Accordingly, shares of our common stock underlying these stock options are eligible for sale in the public markets, subject to vesting restrictions and the lock-up agreements described below.

Lock-up Agreements

      In connection with our initial public offering, we, each of our officers and directors and holders of a majority of our common stock (on an as-converted basis) agreed, with limited exceptions, not to sell or transfer any shares of our common stock prior to May 24, 2004, without first obtaining the written consent of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. In connection with this offering, we, each of our officers and directors, and each of the selling stockholders have agreed, with limited exceptions, not to sell or transfer any shares of our common stock for 90 days after the date of the final prospectus without first obtaining the written consent of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. Specifically, we and these other individuals and entities have agreed not to directly or indirectly:

  •  offer, pledge, sell or contract to sell any common stock,
 
  •  sell any option or contract to purchase any common stock,
 
  •  purchase any option or contract to sell any common stock,
 
  •  grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of any common stock,
 
  •  lend or otherwise dispose of or transfer any common stock,
 
  •  request or demand that we file a registration statement related to the common stock, or
 
  •  enter into any swap or other agreement that transfers, in whole or in part, the economic consequences of ownership of any common stock, whether any such swap or transaction is to be settled by delivery of shares of other securities, in cash or otherwise.

      These lock-up provisions do not limit our ability to grant options to purchase common stock, issue common stock upon the exercise of options or sell stock under our stock option plans. We are also permitted to issue up to 5% of the number of shares of common stock outstanding as of the closing of this offering,

73


Table of Contents

which will equal approximately 904,205 shares, in connection with one or more acquisitions, provided that any recipient of those shares enters into a lock-up agreement with the underwriters for the remainder of the lock-up period described above.

      Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. may waive these lock-up arrangements without public notice. Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. has advised us that it will determine to waive or shorten the lock-ups on a case-by-case basis after considering various factors such as the current equity market condition, the performance of the price of our common stock since the offering, the likely impact of any waiver on the price of our common stock and the requesting party’s reason for making the request. In connection with this offering, Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. has waived the lock-up arrangement for us and the selling stockholders.

Registration Rights

      Under specified circumstances, certain holders of shares of our outstanding common stock have demand registration rights, as described in “Description of Capital Stock — Registration Rights,” with respect to their shares of common stock, and may require us to register their shares of common stock under the Securities Act. In addition, certain holders of our common stock will have piggyback registration rights, as described in “Description of Capital Stock — Registration Rights,” which allows those holders to participate in any future registrations of securities. If the holders of these registrable securities request that we register their shares, and if the registration is effected, these shares will become freely tradable without restriction under the Securities Act. Any sales of securities by these stockholders could have a material adverse effect on the trading price of our common stock.

74


Table of Contents

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL TAX CONSIDERATIONS FOR

NON-U.S. HOLDERS OF OUR COMMON STOCK

      The following is a general discussion of the material U.S. federal income and estate tax considerations applicable to non-U.S. holders with respect to their ownership and disposition of shares of our common stock. This discussion is for general information only and is not tax advice. Accordingly, all prospective non-U.S. holders of our common stock should consult their own tax advisors with respect to the U.S. federal, state, local and foreign tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of our common stock. In general, a “non-U.S. holder” means a beneficial owner of our common stock who is not for U.S. federal income tax purposes:

  •  a citizen or resident of the United States,
 
  •  a corporation or any other organization taxable as a corporation created or organized in the United States or under the laws of the United States or of any state, or
 
  •  an estate or trust, the income of which is included in gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes regardless of its source.

      This discussion is based on current provisions of the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, existing and proposed United States Treasury regulations promulgated thereunder, current administrative rulings and judicial decisions, all of which are in effect as of the date of this prospectus and all of which are subject to change or to different interpretation. Any change, which may or may not be retroactive, could alter the tax consequences to non-U.S. holders described in this prospectus. We assume in this discussion that a non-U.S. holder holds shares of our common stock as a capital asset (generally property held for investment).

      This discussion does not address all aspects of U.S. federal income and estate taxation that may be relevant to a particular non-U.S. holder in light of that non-U.S. holder’s individual circumstances nor does it address any aspects of U.S. state, local or non-U.S. taxes. This discussion also does not consider any specific facts or circumstances that may apply to a non-U.S. holder subject to special treatment under the U.S. federal income tax laws (such as insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, financial institutions, brokers, dealers in securities, partnerships or other pass-through entities, regulated investment companies, pension plans, owners of more than 5% of our common stock and certain U.S. expatriates).

      There can be no assurance that the Internal Revenue Service, the IRS, will not challenge one of the tax consequences described herein, and we have not obtained, nor do we intend to obtain, an opinion of counsel with respect to the United States federal income or estate tax consequences of the purchase, ownership, or disposition of our common stock to a non-U.S. holder. Accordingly, we urge prospective investors to consult with their own tax advisor regarding the U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. income and other tax considerations of acquiring, holding and disposing of shares of our common stock.

Distributions on Our Common Stock

      We have not declared or paid distributions on our common stock since our inception and do not intend to pay any distributions on our common stock in the foreseeable future. In the event we do pay distributions on our common stock, however, these distributions generally will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent paid from our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. If a distribution exceeds our current and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess will be treated as a tax-free return of the holder’s investment, up to the holder’s basis in the common stock. Any remaining excess will be treated as capital gain, subject to the tax treatment described below in “Gain on Sale or Other Disposition of Common Stock.”

      Dividends paid to a non-U.S. holder generally will be subject to withholding of United States federal income tax at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be provided by an applicable income tax treaty between the United States and such holder’s country of residence. If we determine, at a time reasonably close to the date of payment of a distribution on our common stock, that the distribution will not qualify as a dividend

75


Table of Contents

because we do not anticipate having current or accumulated earnings and profits, we intend not to withhold any United States federal income tax on the distribution as permitted by United States Treasury Regulations. If we or another withholding agent withholds tax on such a distribution, a non-U.S. holder may be entitled to a refund of the tax withheld which the non-U.S. holder may claim by filing a United States tax return with the IRS.

      Dividends that are treated as “effectively connected” with a trade or business conducted by a non-U.S. holder within the United States (and if an applicable income tax treaty so provides, are also attributable to a permanent establishment of such non-U.S. holder), known as “United States trade or business income,” are generally exempt from the 30% withholding tax if the non U.S. holder satisfies applicable certification and disclosure requirements. However, such United States trade or business income, net of specified deductions and credits, is taxed at the same graduated United States federal income tax rates applicable to United States persons. Any United States trade or business income received by a non-U.S. holder that is a corporation may also, under certain circumstances, be subject to an additional “branch profits tax” at a 30% rate or such lower rate as specified by an applicable income tax treaty between the United States and such holder’s country of residence.

      A non-U.S. holder of our common stock who claims the benefit of an applicable income tax treaty between the United States and such holder’s country of residence generally will be required to satisfy applicable certification and other requirements. Non-U.S. holders are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding their entitlement to benefits under a relevant income tax treaty.

      A non-U.S. holder that is eligible for a reduced rate of United States withholding tax or other exclusion from withholding under an income tax treaty may obtain a refund or credit of any excess amounts withheld by filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS.

Gain On Sale or Other Disposition of Common Stock

      In general, a non-U.S. holder will not be subject to any U.S. federal income tax or withholding tax on any gain realized upon such holder’s sale or other disposition of shares of our common stock unless:

  •  the gain is United States trade or business income, in which case, unless the non-U.S. holder claims the benefit of an applicable tax treaty as described above, the graduated United States federal income tax rates applicable to United States persons will apply and the branch profits tax described in “Distributions on Our Common Stock” above may apply,
 
  •  the non-U.S. holder is an individual who is present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of the disposition and meets certain other requirements, or
 
  •  the stock constitutes a “United States real property interest” due to our status as a “United States real property holding corporation.”

      Gain recognized on a sale, exchange, or other disposition of common stock may be subject to United States federal income tax (and, in certain circumstances, to withholding tax) if we are, or have been, a United States real property holding corporation during the shorter of the five-year period ending on the date of such sale, exchange, or other disposition or the period that the non-U.S. holder held our common stock. Generally, a corporation is a United States real property holding corporation if the fair market value of its “United States real property interests” equals or exceeds 50% of the sum of the fair market value of its worldwide real property interests plus its other assets used or held for use in a trade or business. Although there can be no assurance, we do not believe that we are, or have been, a United States real property holding corporation, or that we are likely to become one in the future. In addition, if and for so long as our common stock is regularly traded on an established securities market (within the meaning of applicable Treasury regulations), such common stock will be treated as a United States real property interest only if the non-U.S. holder held more than 5% of such regularly traded common stock.

76


Table of Contents

United States Federal Estate Tax

      Shares of our common stock that are owned or treated as owned by an individual non-U.S. holder at the time of death will be included in the individual’s gross estate for U.S. federal estate tax purposes, unless an applicable estate tax or other treaty provides otherwise, and therefore may be subject to U.S. federal estate tax.

Backup Withholding, Information Reporting and Other Reporting Requirements

      A non-U.S. holder may have to comply with specific certification procedures to establish that the holder is not a United States person in order to avoid backup withholding with respect to our payments of dividends on our common stock. We must report annually to the IRS and to each non-U.S. holder the gross amount of any dividends paid to such holder and the tax withheld with respect to those dividends. Dividends paid to non-U.S. holders who are subject to the United States withholding tax, as described above in “Distributions on Our Common Stock” generally will be exempt from United States backup withholding.

      Information reporting and backup withholding (currently at a rate of 28%) will generally apply to the proceeds of a disposition of our common stock by a non-U.S. holder effected by or through the United States office of a broker unless the holder certifies its status as a non-U.S. holder and satisfies certain other qualifications, or otherwise establishes an exemption. Generally, information reporting and backup withholding will not apply to a payment of disposition proceeds where the transaction is effected outside the United States through a non-United States office of a non-United States broker. However, for information reporting purposes, certain brokers with substantial United States ownership or operations generally will be treated in a manner similar to United States brokers. Non-U.S. holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding the application of the information reporting and backup withholding rules to them.

      Copies of information returns may be made available under the provisions of a specific treaty or agreement to the tax authorities of the country in which the non-U.S. holder resides or is incorporated.

      Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules from a payment to a non-U.S. holder can be refunded or credited against the non-U.S. holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS in a timely manner.

77


Table of Contents

UNDERWRITING

      We and the selling stockholders intend to offer the shares through the underwriters. Subject to the terms and conditions described in an underwriting agreement between us, the selling stockholders and Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc., Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc., Piper Jaffray & Co. and Wachovia Capital Markets, LLC, we and the selling stockholders have agreed to sell to the underwriters, and the underwriters severally have agreed to purchase from us and the selling stockholders the number of shares of common stock listed opposite their names below.

           
Underwriter Number of Shares


Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. 
       
Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc. 
       
Piper Jaffray & Co. 
       
Wachovia Capital Markets, LLC 
       
     
 
 
Total
    4,339,384  
     
 

      The underwriters have agreed to purchase all of the shares sold under the underwriting agreement if any of these shares are purchased. If an underwriter defaults, the underwriting agreement provides that the purchase commitments of the non-defaulting underwriters may be increased or the underwriting agreement may be terminated.

      We and the selling stockholders have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or to contribute to payments the underwriters may be required to make in respect of those liabilities.

      The underwriters are offering the shares, subject to prior sale, when, as and if issued to and accepted by them, subject to approval of legal matters by their counsel, including the validity of the shares, and other conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, such as the receipt by the underwriters of officer’s certificates and legal opinions. The underwriters reserve the right to withdraw, cancel or modify offers to the public and to reject orders in whole or in part.

Commissions and Discounts

      The underwriters have advised us that they propose initially to offer the shares to the public at the public offering price on the cover page of this prospectus and to dealers at that price less a concession not in excess of $          per share. The underwriters may allow, and the dealers may reallow, a discount not in excess of $          per share to other dealers. After the public offering, the public offering price, concession and discount may be changed.

      The following table shows the public offering price, underwriting discount and proceeds before expenses to us. The information assumes either no exercise or full exercise by the underwriters of their over-allotment option.

                         
Per Without
Share Option With Option



Public offering price
  $       $       $    
Underwriting discount
  $       $       $    
Proceeds, before expenses, to Open Solutions Inc. 
  $       $       $    
Proceeds, before expenses, to the selling stockholders
  $       $       $    

      The expenses of the offering, excluding the underwriting discount and commissions and related fees, are estimated at $500,000 and are payable by us.

78


Table of Contents

Over-allotment Option

      We have granted the underwriters an option exercisable for 30 days from the date of this prospectus to purchase a total of up to 650,907 additional shares at the public offering price less the underwriting discount. The underwriters may exercise this option solely to cover any over-allotments, if any, made in connection with this offering. To the extent the underwriters exercise this option in whole or in part, each will be obligated, subject to conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, to purchase a number of additional shares approximately proportionate to that underwriter’s initial commitment amount reflected in the above table.

No Sales of Similar Securities

      In connection with our initial public offering, we, each of our officers and directors and holders of substantially all of our common stock agreed, with certain limited exceptions, not to sell or transfer any common stock prior to May 24, 2004 without first obtaining the written consent of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. In connection with this offering, we, each of our officers and directors, and each of the selling stockholders have agreed, with limited exceptions, not to sell or transfer any shares of our common stock for 90 days after the date of the final prospectus without first obtaining the written consent of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. Specifically, we and these other individuals have agreed not to directly or indirectly:

  •  offer, pledge, sell or contract to sell any common stock,
 
  •  sell any option or contract to purchase any common stock,
 
  •  purchase any option or contract to sell any common stock,
 
  •  grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of any common stock,
 
  •  lend or otherwise dispose of or transfer any common stock,
 
  •  request or demand that we file a registration statement related to the common stock, or
 
  •  enter into any swap or other agreement that transfers, in whole or in party, the economic consequences of ownership of any common stock, whether any such swap or transaction is to be settled by delivery of shares or other securities, in cash or otherwise.

      These lock-up provisions do not limit our ability to grant options to purchase common stock, issue common stock upon the exercise of options or sell stock under our stock incentive plans. We are also permitted to issue up to 5% of the number of shares of common stock outstanding as of the closing of this offering, which will equal approximately 904,205 shares, in connection with one or more acquisitions, provided that any recipient of those shares enters into a lock-up agreement with the underwriters for the remainder of the lock-up period described above.

      Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. may waive these lock-up arrangements without public notice. Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. has advised us that it will determine to waive or shorten the lock-ups on a case-by-case basis after considering various factors such as the current equity market condition, the performance of the price of our common stock since the offering, the likely impact of any waiver on the price of our common stock and the requesting party’s reason for making the request. In connection with this offering, Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. has waived the lock-up arrangement for us and the selling stockholders.

Quotation on the Nasdaq National Market

      Our common stock is quoted on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol “OPEN.”

Price Stabilization, Short Positions

      Until the distribution of the shares is completed, SEC rules may limit the underwriters from bidding for and purchasing our common stock. However, the underwriters may engage in transactions that stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the price of our common stock during and after this offering.

      If the underwriters over-allot or otherwise create a short position in our common stock in connection with the offering, i.e., if they sell more shares than are listed on the cover of this prospectus, the underwriters may reduce that short position by purchasing shares in the open market. The underwriters may also elect to

79


Table of Contents

reduce any short position by exercising all or part of the over-allotment option described above. In addition, the underwriters may impose penalty bids, under which selling concessions allowed to syndicate members or other broker-dealers participating in this offering are reclaimed if shares of our common stock previously distributed in this offering are repurchased in connection with stabilization transactions or otherwise. These transactions to stabilize or maintain the market price may cause the price of our common stock to be higher than it might be in the absence of such transactions. The imposition of a penalty bid may also affect the price of our common stock to the extent that it discourages resales.

      Neither we nor any of the underwriters makes any representation or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of our common stock. In addition, neither we nor any of the underwriters makes any representation that they will engage in these transactions or that these transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.

Passive Market Making

      In connection with this offering, the underwriters may engage in passive market making transactions in our common stock on the Nasdaq National Market in accordance with Rule 103 of Regulation M under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during a period before the commencement of offers or sales of common stock and extending through the completion of distribution. A passive market maker must display its bid at a price not in excess of the highest independent bid of that security. However, if all independent bids are lowered below the passive market maker’s bid, that bid must then be lowered when specified purchase limits are exceeded.

Other Relationships

      In connection with this offering, the underwriters may allocate shares to accounts over which they exercise discretionary authority. The underwriters do not expect to allocate shares to discretionary accounts in excess of 5% of the total number of shares in this offering.

      A senior managing director of Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. is a member of the board of directors of The BISYS Group, Inc., one of our strategic partners and the beneficial owner of 3.36% of our common stock as of April 15, 2004.

      Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future perform, various financial advisory and investment banking services for us, for which they received or will receive customary fees and expenses. In particular, Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc., Friedman, Billings Ramsey & Co. and Piper Jaffray & Co., acted as underwriters in connection with our initial public offering of common stock in December 2003 for which they received customary fees and expenses.

80


Table of Contents

LEGAL MATTERS

      The validity of the shares of common stock offered by Open Solutions will be passed upon for Open Solutions by Hale and Dorr LLP, Boston, Massachusetts. Various legal matters related to the sale of the common stock offered hereby will be passed upon for the underwriters by Latham & Watkins LLP, New York, New York.

EXPERTS

      The financial statements of Open Solutions as of December 31, 2002 and 2003 and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2003 included in this prospectus have been so included in reliance on the report of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, independent accountants, given on the authority of said firm as experts in auditing and accounting.

      The financial statements of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. as of December 31, 2001 and 2002 and June 30, 2003, and for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 and the six months ended June 30, 2003 included in this prospectus have been so included in reliance on the report of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, independent accountants, given on the authority of said firm as experts in auditing and accounting.

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

      We have filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission a registration statement on Form S-1 (File Number 333-                    ) under the Securities Act of 1933 with respect to the shares of common stock offered hereby. This prospectus does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement, portions of which are omitted as permitted by the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission. For further information pertaining to us and the common stock to be sold in the offering, reference is made to the registration statement, including the exhibits thereto and the financial statements, notes and schedules filed as a part thereof. Statements contained in this prospectus regarding the contents of any contract or other document referred to herein or therein are not necessarily complete, and in each instance reference is made to the copy of such contract or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement or such other document, each such statement being qualified in all respects by such reference.

      We are subject to the informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and will file reports, proxy statements and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission. Such reports, proxy statements and other information, as well as the registration statement and the exhibits and schedules thereto, may be inspected, without charge, at the public reference facility maintained by the Securities and Exchange Commission at 450 Fifth Street, NW, Washington, D.C. 20549. Copies of such material may also be obtained from the Public Reference Section of the Securities and Exchange Commission at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, at prescribed rates. You may obtain information on the operation of the SEC public reference room in Washington, D.C. by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. Such materials can also be inspected on the Securities and Exchange Commission’s website at www.sec.gov.

81


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

      The following unaudited pro forma combined condensed financial information gives effect to our acquisition of substantially all of the assets and assumption of substantially all of the liabilities of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. from Liberty Enterprises, Inc., which was consummated on July 1, 2003. The unaudited pro forma combined condensed statements of operations for the year ended December 31, 2003 have been prepared as if the acquisition had occurred at January 1, 2003, the beginning of the fiscal period presented. The notes to the pro forma combined condensed financial information describe certain pro forma adjustments to give effect to the purchase transaction had it been consummated at that date.

      The unaudited pro forma combined condensed financial information has been derived from our historical consolidated financial statements and those of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. and should be read in conjunction with those financial statements and notes, the accompanying notes to the pro forma combined condensed financial statements, and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” all of which are included elsewhere in this prospectus. The unaudited pro forma combined condensed financial statements are not necessarily indicative of operating results which would have been achieved had the transaction actually been completed at the beginning of the respective periods.

P-1


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA COMBINED CONDENSED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

Year Ended December 31, 2003
                                     
Liberty
FiTech Pro Forma
Open Systems, Adjustments Pro Forma
Solutions Inc. (Note 2) Combined




(in thousands, except share and per share data)
Revenues
  $ 63,852     $ 6,880     $     $ 70,732  
Cost of revenues
    28,881       4,477       (202 )(a)     33,156  
     
     
     
     
 
 
Gross profit
    34,971       2,403       202       37,576  
Operating expenses
                               
 
Sales and marketing
    10,729       1,223       7 (b)     11,959  
 
Product development
    6,854       184             7,038  
 
General and administrative
    15,888       2,802       30 (c)     18,720  
     
     
     
     
 
   
Total operating expenses
    33,471       4,209       37       37,717  
     
     
     
     
 
Income (loss) from operations
    1,500       (1,806 )     165       (141 )
 
Interest and other income (expense), net
    43       (277 )     132 (d)     (102 )
     
     
     
     
 
Income (loss) before income taxes
    1,543       (2,083 )     297       (243 )
 
Income tax provision
    (234 )                 (234 )
     
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss)
  $ 1,309     $ (2,083 )   $ 297     $ (477 )
Preferred stock accretion charge
    (31,500 )                 (31,500 )
     
     
     
     
 
Net loss attributable to common stockholders
  $ (30,191 )   $ (2,083 )   $ 297     $ (31,977 )
     
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss) per shares — basic and diluted
  $ (7.74 )                   $ (8.19 )
Weighted average common shares — basic and diluted
    3,903,252                       3,903,252  

See accompanying notes.

P-2


Table of Contents

NOTES TO UNAUDITED PROFORMA COMBINED CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share data)

Note 1 — The Transaction

      On July 1, 2003, we acquired substantially all of the assets of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. and assumed certain liabilities and the related future software maintenance and support obligations for a purchase price of $11,704, consisting of $8,000 in cash, a $1,904 promissory note and 133,195 shares of our common stock. The promissory note had an annual rate of interest of 5.00% and was due in installments of $1,704 on June 30, 2004 and $200 on December 31, 2004. We repaid the note in full upon the closing of our initial public offering in December 2003.

      The 133,195 shares of common stock issued to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. were subject to a put and call agreement, under which (i) Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. had the right to require us to purchase these shares upon the closing of this offering at a price of $13.51 per share, and (ii) we had the right to require Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. to sell these shares to us upon the closing of this offering at a price of $13.51 per share. These rights were exercisable by either party at the earlier of (i) an initial public offering, or (ii) anytime during the period from June 30, 2004 through June 30, 2005. On September 3, 2003, FS Acquisition, Inc., the successor-in-interest to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc., exercised its put right pursuant to this put and call agreement with respect to these shares. Accordingly, on the date of the closing of our initial public offering in December 2003, we purchased these 133,195 shares at a price of $13.51 per share, or an aggregate of $1,800.

      The purchase price of the transaction was as follows (in thousands):

         
Cash
  $ 8,000  
Promissory note
    1,904  
Shares subject to redemption
    1,800  
Transaction costs
    260  
     
 
    $ 11,964  

      The acquisition was recorded under the purchase method and total consideration was allocated to the fair value of assets and liabilities acquired as follows (in thousands):

         
Current assets
  $ 2,090  
Fixed assets
    1,916  
Purchased technology
    530  
Goodwill
    4,817  
Intangible assets
    6,700  
Accounts payable and accrued expenses
    (292 )
Capital lease obligations
    (666 )
Deferred revenue
    (3,131 )
     
 
    $ 11,964  

Note 2 — Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Condensed Statement of Operations for the Year Ended December 31, 2003

      Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. was acquired on July 1, 2003 and the results of its operations are included in our statement of operations from the date of acquisition through December 31, 2003. The following

P-3


Table of Contents

adjustments were applied to our historical statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2003 and that of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. for the six months ended June 30, 2003 (in thousands):
             
(a)
  To record the following for the six months ended June 30, 2003:
    Incremental amortization of our purchased technology   $ 53  
    Elimination of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. amortization of capitalized software     (255 )
         
 
        $ (202 )
    The amortization of purchased technology has been calculated based on a new fair value basis of $530, amortized over five years. The purchased technology will be amortized over its useful life of five years in accordance with SFAS No. 86, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software to Be Sold, Leased, or Otherwise Marketed, based on the greater of the (a) ratio that current gross revenues for a product bear to the total of current and anticipated future gross revenues for that product or (b) the straight-line method over the remaining economic life of the product. We estimate that the straight-line method will approximate the ratio of current gross revenues to the total of current and anticipated future gross revenues.        
(b)
  To record the following for the six months ended June 30, 2003:        
    Incremental amortization of our purchased customer lists   $ 279  
    Elimination of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. amortization of customer lists     (272 )
         
 
        $ 7  
    The amortization of customer lists has been calculated based on a new fair value basis of $6,700, amortized over 12 years. Customer lists will be amortized over their useful life in accordance with SFAS No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, based on the pattern in which economic benefits of the intangible asset are consumed or otherwise used up. We estimate that the pattern in which economic benefits are consumed or otherwise used up approximates the straight-line method.        
 
(c)
  To record the following for the six months ended June 30, 2003:        
    Incremental depreciation of our fixed assets   $ 319  
    Elimination of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. depreciation of fixed assets     (289 )
         
 
        $ 30  
    The amortization of fixed assets has been calculated based on a new fair value basis of $1,911, depreciated over three years.
 
(d)
  To record the following for the six months ended June 30, 2003:        
    Incremental interest expense for note payable ($1,904 at a 5% interest rate) related to the acquisition   $ (48 )
    Decrease in interest income related to use of $8,000 in cash for the acquisition, using a 1.52% interest rate     (61 )
    Elimination of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. interest expense as a result of elimination of intercompany note payable     241  
         
 
        $ 132  

P-4


Table of Contents

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

         
Page

Open Solutions Inc.
       
Report of Independent Auditors
    F-2  
Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2002 and 2003
    F-3  
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003
    F-4  
Consolidated Statements of Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock and Stockholders’ Equity (Deficit) for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003
    F-5  
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003
    F-6  
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
    F-7  
 
Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. (a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)        
Report of Independent Accountants
    F-31  
Balance Sheets at December 31, 2001 and 2002 and June 30, 2003
    F-32  
Statements of Operations and Accumulated Deficit for the Years Ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 and the Six Months Ended June 30, 2002 (unaudited) and 2003
    F-33  
Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 and the Six Months Ended June 30, 2002 (unaudited) and 2003
    F-34  
Notes to Financial Statements
    F-35  

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders

of Open Solutions Inc.:

      In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of operations, of redeemable convertible preferred stock and stockholders’ equity (deficit) and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Open Solutions Inc. and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2002 and 2003, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2003 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management; our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits of these statements in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America, which require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

/s/ PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS LLP

Hartford, Connecticut

February 24, 2004

F-2


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

                     
December 31,

2002 2003


(In thousands, except
share and per share data)
ASSETS
Current assets:
               
 
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 11,414     $ 84,953  
 
Accounts receivable, net
    7,946       10,267  
 
Deferred costs
    1,220       1,563  
 
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
    885       2,188  
     
     
 
   
Total current assets
    21,465       98,971  
 
Fixed assets, net
    4,577       5,500  
 
Investments in marketable securities
          8,028  
 
Capitalized software cost, net
    3,574       2,964  
 
Other intangible assets, net
          6,421  
 
Goodwill
    6,223       11,187  
     
     
 
   
Total assets
  $ 35,839     $ 133,071  
     
     
 
 
LIABILITIES, REDEEMABLE CONVERTIBLE PREFERRED STOCK
AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)
Current liabilities:
               
 
Accounts payable
  $ 2,161     $ 1,800  
 
Accrued expenses
    4,818       8,368  
 
Deferred revenue, current portion
    12,250       15,324  
 
Long-term debt from related party, current portion
    750        
 
Capital lease obligations, current portion
          395  
     
     
 
   
Total current liabilities
    19,979       25,887  
     
     
 
 
Long-term debt from related party, less current portion
    700        
 
Capital lease obligations, less current portion
          64  
 
Deferred revenue, less current portion
    722       1,479  
 
Other long-term liabilities
    119       222  
     
     
 
   
Total liabilities
    21,520       27,652  
     
     
 
 
Commitments and contingencies (Note 13) 
               
Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
               
 
Mandatorily redeemable convertible preferred stock
    31,100        
 
Redeemable convertible preferred stock
    26,480        
Stockholders’ Equity (Deficit)
               
 
Preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 5,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2003
           
 
Common stock, $0.01 par value; 45,000,000 and 95,000,000 shares authorized; 2,474,917 and 16,786,329 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2002 and 2003, respectively
    25       168  
 
Additional paid-in capital
    5,018       152,274  
 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
          (28 )
 
Accumulated deficit
    (48,304 )     (46,995 )
     
     
 
   
Total stockholders’ equity (deficit)
    (43,261 )     105,419  
     
     
 
   
Total liabilities, redeemable convertible preferred stock and stockholders’ equity (deficit)
  $ 35,839     $ 133,071  
     
     
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-3


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

                             
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



(In thousands, except
share and per share data)
Revenues:
                       
 
Software license
  $ 9,971     $ 13,449     $ 21,391  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    17,295       30,896       42,461  
     
     
     
 
   
Total revenues
    27,266       44,345       63,852  
     
     
     
 
Cost of revenues:
                       
 
Software license
    1,592       3,152       5,341  
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    10,084       18,430       23,540  
     
     
     
 
   
Total cost of revenues
    11,676       21,582       28,881  
     
     
     
 
 
Gross profit
    15,590       22,763       34,971  
     
     
     
 
Operating expenses:
                       
 
Sales and marketing
    8,771       9,533       10,729  
 
Product development
    7,643       6,223       6,854  
 
General and administrative (includes restricted stock expense and related taxes of $3,444 for the year ended December 31, 2003: Note 11)
    9,068       10,017       15,888  
 
In-process research and development
    447              
     
     
     
 
   
Total operating expenses
    25,929       25,773       33,471  
     
     
     
 
Income (loss) from operations
    (10,339 )     (3,010 )     1,500  
 
Interest income and other, net
    432       172       197  
 
Interest expense
    (4 )     (27 )     (154 )
     
     
     
 
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (9,911 )     (2,865 )     1,543  
Income tax (provision) benefit
    250       (32 )     (234 )
     
     
     
 
Net income (loss)
    (9,661 )     (2,897 )     1,309  
Preferred stock accretion charge (Note 10)
                (31,500 )
     
     
     
 
Net loss attributable to common stockholders
  $ (9,661 )   $ (2,897 )   $ (30,191 )
     
     
     
 
Net loss per common share:
                       
 
 — Basic
  $ (4.71 )   $ (1.18 )   $ (7.74 )
 
 — Diluted
    (4.71 )     (1.18 )     (7.74 )
Weighted average common shares used to compute net loss per common share:
                       
 
 — Basic
    2,050,606       2,452,848       3,903,252  
 
 — Diluted
    2,050,606       2,452,848       3,903,252  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-4


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF REDEEMABLE CONVERTIBLE

PREFERRED STOCK AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)
                                                                                         
Mandatorily
Redeemable Redeemable
Convertible Preferred Convertible Preferred Accumulated Total
Stock Stock Common Stock Additional Other Stockholders’



Paid-In Deferred Comprehensive Accumulated Equity
Shares Amount Shares Amount Shares Amount Capital Compensation Loss Deficit (Deficit)











(In thousands, except share and per share data)
Balance at December 31, 2000
    2,167,385     $ 20,084       6,055,671     $ 24,744       2,004,697     $ 20     $ 1,975     $     $     $ (35,746 )   $ (33,751 )
Sale of mandatorily redeemable convertible preferred stock
    1,190,986       11,016                                                        
Exercise of stock warrants
                204,513       1,013                                            
Exercise of stock options
                            12,071             30                         30  
Issuance of stock for acquisitions
                80,472       723       369,986       4       2,679                         2,683  
Net loss
                                                          (9,661 )     (9,661 )
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
Balance at December 31, 2001
    3,358,371       31,100       6,340,656       26,480       2,386,754       24       4,684                   (45,407 )     (40,699 )
Exercise of stock options
                            88,163       1       187                         188  
Expiration of vested stock options
                                        147                         147  
Net loss
                                                          (2,897 )     (2,897 )
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
Balance at December 31, 2002
    3,358,371       31,100       6,340,656       26,480       2,474,917       25       5,018                   (48,304 )     (43,261 )
Exercise of stock options
                            7,943             10                         10  
Issuance of restricted stock
                            680,530       7       3,269       (3,276 )                  
Amortization of deferred compensation
                                              3,276                   3,276  
Tax provision related to restricted stock
                                        72                         72  
Issuance of common stock
                            5,570,000       56       87,891                         87,947  
Issuance cost from sale of common stock
                                        (1,545 )                       (1,545 )
Preferred stock accretion charge
          31,500                               (31,500 )                       (31,500 )
Conversion of preferred stock
    (3,358,371 )     (62,600 )     (6,340,656 )     (26,480 )     8,052,939       80       89,036                         89,116  
Deemed preferred stock dividends and accretion
                                        (37 )                       (37 )
Unrealized loss on marketable securities
                                                    (28 )           (28 )
Forfeiture of stock options
                                        60                         60  
Net income
                                                          1,309       1,309  
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
Balance at December 31, 2003
        $           $       16,786,329     $ 168     $ 152,274     $     $ (28 )   $ (46,995 )   $ 105,419  
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-5


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

                               
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



(In thousands, except
share and per share data)
Cash flows from operating activities
                       
 
Net income (loss)
  $ (9,661 )   $ (2,897 )   $ 1,309  
 
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:
                       
   
Depreciation and amortization
    3,023       3,236       3,901  
   
Compensation expense related to stock and options granted
    156       84       3,542  
   
Tax benefit on restricted stock
                72  
   
In-process research and development
    447              
   
Provision for doubtful accounts
    195       270       205  
 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities, excluding effects from acquisitions:
                       
   
Accounts receivable
    407       (292 )     (1,038 )
   
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
    (475 )     (614 )     (1,299 )
   
Accounts payable and accrued expenses
    260       (180 )     2,586  
   
Deferred revenue
    2,316       3,095       791  
     
     
     
 
     
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
    (3,332 )     2,702       10,069  
     
     
     
 
Cash flows from investing activities
                       
 
Purchases of fixed assets
    (1,889 )     (1,666 )     (1,469 )
 
Purchase of developed software
    (320 )     (50 )     (20 )
 
Purchase of marketable securities
                (8,056 )
 
Business acquisitions, net of cash received
    (3,397 )           (8,037 )
 
Business acquired from related party
          (564 )      
     
     
     
 
     
Net cash used in investing activities
    (5,606 )     (2,280 )     (17,582 )
     
     
     
 
Cash flows from financing activities
                       
 
Proceeds from sale of mandatorily redeemable convertible preferred stock
    11,100              
 
Issuance costs related to sale of mandatorily redeemable preferred stock
    (84 )            
 
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
    30       188       10  
 
Proceeds from exercise of warrants
    1,013              
 
Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt
                1,661  
 
Repayment of long-term debt
    (91 )     (748 )     (5,014 )
 
Repayment of capital lease obligation
                (207 )
 
Purchase of common stock
                (1,800 )
 
Proceeds from sale of common stock
                87,947  
 
Issuance costs from sale of common stock
                (1,545 )
     
     
     
 
     
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    11,968       (560 )     81,052  
     
     
     
 
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    3,030       (138 )     73,539  
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period
    8,522       11,552       11,414  
     
     
     
 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period
  $ 11,552     $ 11,414     $ 84,953  
     
     
     
 
Supplemental disclosures
                       
 
Cash paid for interest
  $ 3     $     $ 178  
 
Cash paid for income taxes
    2       32       118  
See Notes 4, 9 and 10 for additional non-cash disclosures
                       

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-6


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 
1. The Company

      Open Solutions Inc., (the “Company”), is a provider of software and services that allow financial institutions to compete and service their customers more effectively. The Company develops, markets, licenses and supports an enterprise-wide suite of software and services that performs a financial institution’s data processing and information management functions. The Company’s software can be operated either by the financial institution itself on an outsourced basis in one of the Company’s outsourcing centers or through an outsourcing center hosted by one of the Company’s resellers.

      The Company was incorporated in 1992 and operates principally in Glastonbury, Connecticut. On December 2, 2003, the Company completed an initial public offering raising proceeds, net of expenses, of $86,402,000.

      On November 24, 2003, the Company effected a 1:1.45 reverse stock split of the Company’s common stock, par value $.01 per share. All share and per share amounts for all years presented have been adjusted for the reverse stock split.

 
2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
 
Use of Estimates

      The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Certain reclassifications to the prior year information have been made to conform with the current year classifications.

 
Principles of Consolidation

      The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiaries Open Solutions Imaging Systems, Inc. (successor-in-interest to Imagic Corporation), Sound Software Development, Inc. and Open Solutions FiTech, Inc. (successor-in-interest to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc.). All significant accounts, transactions and profits between the consolidated companies have been eliminated in consolidation. Significant accounts and transactions between the Company, including its subsidiaries, and its directors, officers, and stockholders, are disclosed as related party transactions (see Note 15).

 
Segment Reporting

      The Company applies the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 131, Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information. The Company views its operations and manages its business as one segment, the development and marketing of computer software and related services. Factors used to identify the Company’s single operating segment include the organizational structure of the Company and the financial information available for evaluation by the chief operating decision-maker in making decisions about how to allocate resources and assess performance. The Company operates primarily

F-7


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

in one geographical area, the United States of America. The Company provides the following disclosures of revenues from products and services:

                         
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



Software license
  $ 9,971,000     $ 13,449,000     $ 21,391,000  
     
     
     
 
Installation, training and professional services
    7,362,000       9,519,000       10,686,000  
Maintenance, support and data center services
    9,560,000       17,180,000       28,507,000  
Hardware
    373,000       4,197,000       3,268,000  
     
     
     
 
Service, maintenance and hardware
    17,295,000       30,896,000       42,461,000  
     
     
     
 
Total revenue
  $ 27,266,000     $ 44,345,000     $ 63,852,000  
     
     
     
 
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents

      Cash and cash equivalents include cash on deposit with banks, and all highly liquid marketable securities with original maturities of three months or less at the date of acquisition. The Company also classifies short term commercial paper with monthly call dates as cash equivalents.

 
Investments in Marketable Securities

      The Company’s investments consist primarily of corporate bonds that are held with a major financial institution. At December 31, 2003, Open Solutions, Inc. classified its entire investment portfolio as available-for-sale as defined in SFAS No. 115, Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities. The specific identification method is used to determine the cost basis and calculate unrealized gains and losses. Securities are recorded at fair value, and unrealized gains and losses on these investments are included as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of any related tax effect.

 
Accounts Receivable

      The Company makes judgments as to its ability to collect outstanding receivables and provide allowances for the portion of receivables when collection becomes doubtful. Provisions are made based upon a specific review of all significant outstanding invoices and recorded in the allowance for doubtful accounts. Receivables are presented net of the allowance for doubtful accounts.

      The following table represents the activity for the allowance for doubtful accounts during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003:

                                         
Additions
Balance at
Beginning Charge to Costs Charge to Deductions, Balance at
Description of Period and Expenses Other Accounts Net End of Period






Allowance for Doubtful Accounts:
                                       
Years ended December 31,
                                       
2001
    645,000       195,000             267,000       573,000  
2002
    573,000       270,000             425,000       418,000  
2003
  $ 418,000     $ 205,000     $     $ 203,000     $ 420,000  

F-8


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

 
Fixed Assets

      Fixed assets are stated at cost and are depreciated using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets as follows:

         
Computer Equipment
    5  years  
Office furniture and equipment
    7  years  
Leasehold Improvements
    7  years  

      Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the term of the lease or the useful life of the asset.

 
Capitalized Software Costs

      Capitalized software costs are primarily comprised of the costs associated with purchased technology acquired in acquisitions, software directly purchased from third-party vendors and internally developed software (see discussion in Note 4 and Note 6). Capitalized costs related to software to be sold, leased, or otherwise marketed are accounted for pursuant to SFAS No. 86, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software to be Sold, Leased, or Otherwise Marketed. These costs are amortized over the estimated economic useful life of the software, which is generally 5 to 7 years. The Company’s policy is to record amortization for purchased technology based on the greater of the amount computed using (a) the ratio that current gross revenues for a product bear to the total of current and anticipated future gross revenues for that product or (b) the straight-line method over the remaining estimated economic life of the product, including the period being reported on. The Company reassesses this estimate periodically. At each balance sheet date, the Company compares the carrying value of the capitalized software to the net realizable value of the product, determined using management’s estimate of discounted cash flows. Any excess of carrying value over net realizable value is written off. To date, the Company has not recorded any impairment on its capitalized software.

      The Company capitalizes certain costs related to the development and purchase of internal-use software pursuant to Statement of Position No. 98-1, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use. Under SOP No. 98-1, computer software costs incurred in the preliminary project stage are expensed as incurred until the capitalization criteria have been met. The criteria for capitalization is defined as the point the preliminary project stage is complete and management commits to funding a computer software project and it is probable that the project will be completed and the software will be used to perform the function intended. Capitalization ceases at the point that the computer software project is substantially complete and ready for its intended use. The capitalized costs are amortized using the straight-line method over the estimated economic life of the product, generally three years.

 
Research and Development Costs

      Research and development costs, which are described as product development costs in the consolidated statement of operations, are expensed as incurred. Software development costs for new software products and additional modules for existing software are expensed as incurred until technological feasibility is established, in accordance with SFAS No. 86, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software to be Sold, Leased or Otherwise Marketed. Technological feasibility is established at the point in which a working model of the product has been completed and completeness of the working model and its consistency with the product design has been confirmed by testing. The establishment of technological feasibility of our products has substantially coincided with the general release of such software. As a result, internal software development costs qualifying for capitalization under SFAS No. 86 have not been significant.

F-9


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

 
Long-Lived Assets

      The Company evaluates its long-lived assets, which are comprised primarily of fixed assets and capitalized internal-use software, for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of an asset group to future undiscounted net cash flows expected to be generated by the asset group. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the fair value of the assets. The Company did not recognize any impairment loss for long-lived assets in 2001, 2002 or 2003.

 
Goodwill and other Intangibles

      In 2001, the Company adopted SFAS No. 141, Business Combinations, and SFAS No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, for its business combinations, goodwill, and other intangible assets. The acquisitions described in Note 4 were accounted for using the purchase method with a total of $11,187,000 assigned to goodwill. The recorded goodwill related to the Company’s acquisitions was acquired after the adoption of SFAS No. 142 and, as a result, has not been subject to amortization. Other intangible assets, such as purchased technology, continue to be amortized over their useful lives (see Note 6). The Company performs an annual impairment test of its goodwill at December 31. To accomplish this, the Company identifies its reporting units and determines the carrying value of each reporting unit by assigning the assets and liabilities, including the existing goodwill and intangible assets, to those reporting units and comparing such amounts to the respective fair values of each reporting unit. As of December 31, 2003, the Company had four reporting units. Based on the results of the annual impairment analysis, the Company has determined that no impairment existed for its reporting units.

 
Revenue Recognition

      The Company generates revenues from licensing the rights to use its software products and certain third-party software products to end-users. The Company also generates revenues from customer support and maintenance, installation, professional service and training services provided to customers, data center services and hardware sales related to its imaging business. The Company’s maintenance and support arrangements offer call center support and unspecified upgrades and enhancements on software products on a when-and-if-available basis.

      The Company recognizes revenue in accordance with AICPA Statement of Position (“SOP”) 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition. Under SOP 97-2, the Company recognizes software license revenue when a non-cancelable license agreement has been executed, fees are fixed and determinable, the software has been delivered, accepted by the customer if acceptance is required by the contract and is other than perfunctory, and collection is considered probable.

      The Company sells software licenses in conjunction with professional services for installation and maintenance. For these arrangements, the total contract value is attributed first to the maintenance arrangement based on its fair value, which is derived from renewal rates. The contract value is then attributed to installation and training services based on estimated fair value, which is derived from the rates charged for similar services provided on a stand-alone basis multiplied by estimated hours to complete. The Company’s software license agreements generally do not require significant modification or customization of the underlying software, and accordingly, installation and training services are not considered essential to functionality. The remainder of the total contract value is then attributed to the software license and other delivered elements based on the residual method described in SOP 98-9, Modification of SOP 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition, With Respect to Certain Transactions. If customization of the Company’s software is required, the Company recognizes revenue using the percentage-of-completion method. Maintenance revenues

F-10


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

are recognized ratably over the maintenance period, generally five years. Revenues from installation and training services are recognized as services are performed. The Company warrants its products will function substantially in accordance with documentation provided to customers. To date, the Company has not incurred any significant expenses related to warranty claims.

      Deferred revenue is comprised of payments received related to product delivery, maintenance and other services, which have been paid by customers prior to the recognition of revenue. Deferred costs are comprised of costs incurred prior to the recognition of the related revenue.

      Data center revenues associated with allowing customers to utilize our software products on an outsourced basis are recognized in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101, Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements. Specifically, revenues are recognized when evidence of an arrangement exists, fees are fixed and determinable, collectibility is reasonably assured, and delivery has occurred. The Company obtains signed contracts, which indicate the key terms, as well as the fixed and determinable fees, in each arrangement. Revenues associated with installation of data center arrangements are recognized as services are performed, and revenues from data center services are recognized over the term of the arrangement, typically 3 to 5 years. The total contract value is allocated based on the relative fair value of the installation and data center services.

      The Company is receiving payments under certain license and marketing agreements with resellers. The Company has provided a master license to its two primary resellers and does not have any other continuing obligation to provide additional products or services, other than the provision of client support and maintenance. The Company recognizes license revenue when the revenue recognition criteria under SOP No. 97-2 are met, including when evidence of an arrangement exists, fees are fixed and determinable, collectibility is reasonably assured, and delivery has occurred. The revenue for client support and maintenance is recognized ratably over the period of maintenance, generally 3 to 5 years.

      Pursuant to its amended license agreement with BISYS, Inc. (“BISYS”) on September 30, 2003 (see Note 16), the Company is entitled to non-refundable license fees, payable at the beginning of each quarter. The Company also receives additional license fees for amounts that are sold above the minimum license fee threshold, which are payable at the end of each quarter. The Company records the quarterly minimum license fee and the additional license fees as revenue in the period in which they are due and payable.

      From January 1, 2002 through December 31, 2003, the Company had received license fees from BISYS, which were due and payable upon the occurrence of certain events which were communicated by BISYS. The Company recognized these license fees when non-refundable amounts were due and payable under the agreement, assuming that all other revenue recognition criteria were met. Prior to January 1, 2002, BISYS paid license fees over a period of 36 months, and the Company recognized these fees ratably over the payment term.

      Pursuant to its amended license agreement with its regional reseller on May 15, 2003 (see Note 16), the Company receives payments upon signing and upon conversion of a financial institution. The Company recognizes revenue upon signing of a financial institution, assuming all other revenue recognition criteria have been met.

      Prior to May 15, 2003, the Company received payments from its regional reseller upon conversion of a financial institution. For these arrangements, the Company recognized revenue upon the conversion of the financial institution, assuming all other revenue recognition was met.

      The Company’s hardware revenue related to its check imaging products is recognized on a percentage-of-completion basis under the method described in SOP 81-1, because installation services and the related software to these arrangements are considered essential to the functionality of certain of the hardware. Percentage-of-completion for services related to the Company’s check imaging product arrangements is

F-11


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

measured by the total hours incurred to date for each contract compared to the estimated total hours to complete that contract. The Company records provisions for estimated losses on contracts in the period in which such losses become known. Changes in estimates of sales, costs, and profits are recognized in the period which they are determined using the cumulative catch-up method of accounting. If the software is not essential to the functionality of the hardware, the Company recognizes hardware revenue upon delivery.

 
Income Taxes

      The Company accounts for income taxes in accordance with SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes.” Under SFAS 109, an asset and liability approach is used to recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequences of items that have already been recognized in its financial statements and tax returns. A valuation allowance is established against net deferred tax assets if, based on the weight of available evidence, it is more likely than not that some or all of the net deferred tax assets will not be realized.

 
Net Income and Loss Per Share

      The Company reports net income or loss per share in accordance with SFAS No. 128, Earnings per Share (“EPS”). Under SFAS No. 128, basic EPS, which excludes dilution, is computed by dividing income or loss available to common stockholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Net income or loss available to common stockholders represents reported net income or loss less accretion of mandatorily redeemable convertible preferred stock. All earnings per share and weighted average shares outstanding have been restated to reflect the 1:1.45 reverse stock split which was effected on November 24, 2003.

      Diluted EPS reflects the potential dilution that could occur if securities or other contracts to issue common stock were exercised or converted into common stock. Diluted EPS includes in-the-money stock options and warrants using the treasury stock method and also includes the assumed conversion of preferred stock using the if-converted method. During a loss period, the assumed exercise of in-the-money stock options and warrants and the conversion of convertible preferred stock has an anti-dilutive effect, and therefore, these instruments are excluded from the computation of dilutive EPS. Weighted average common shares of 8,800,303, 9,025,381 and 7,168,026 were excluded from the computation of diluted EPS the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, respectively, as they would have been anti-dilutive.

 
Comprehensive Income

      SFAS No. 130, Reporting Comprehensive Income, requires that items defined as comprehensive income or loss be separately classified in the financial statements and that the accumulated balance of other comprehensive income or loss be reported separately from accumulated deficit and additional paid-in capital in the equity section of the balance sheet.

      The following table summarizes the Company’s comprehensive income (loss):

                           
Years Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



Net income (loss)
  $ (9,661,000 )   $ (2,897,000 )   $ 1,309,000  
Unrealized loss on marketable securities
                (28,000 )
     
     
     
 
 
Total comprehensive income (loss)
  $ (9,661,000 )   $ (2,897,000 )   $ 1,281,000  
     
     
     
 
 
Concentration of Credit Risk

      Financial instruments that potentially expose the Company to concentrations of credit risk are limited to accounts receivable. No individual customer accounted for 10% or more of total revenues for the years ended

F-12


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

December 31, 2002 or 2003. During 2001, revenue from an individual customer accounted for approximately 11% of total revenues.

      For the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2003, no customer accounted for 10% or more of the total accounts receivable balance. For the year ended December 31, 2002 an individual customer accounted for 25% of the account receivable balance. The Company maintains allowances for potential credit risks and otherwise controls this risk through monitoring procedures.

 
Fair Value of Financial Instruments

      The carrying amount of cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued expenses approximate fair value because of the short maturity of those instruments. The carrying amount of long-term debt approximates fair value, and a fluctuation in interest rates would not be material to the Company’s financial position.

 
Recent Accounting Pronouncements

      In November 2002, the Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) issued EITF Issue No. 00-21, Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables. This issue addresses revenue recognition for arrangements with multiple deliverables which should be considered as separate units of accounting if the deliverables meet certain criteria as described in EITF 00-21. This issue is effective for revenue arrangements entered into in fiscal periods beginning after June 15, 2003. Early adoption is permitted. The adoption of this standard on July 1, 2003 did not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

      In January 2003, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 46, Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities. This interpretation addresses the consolidation of business enterprises (variable interest entities) to which the usual condition of consolidation does not apply. This interpretation focuses on financial interests that indicate control. Variable interests may arise from financial instruments, service contracts, nonvoting ownership interests and other arrangements. If an enterprise holds a majority of the variable interests of an entity, it would be considered the primary beneficiary. The primary beneficiary would be required to include assets, liabilities and the results of operations of the variable interest entity in its financial statements. In December 2003, the FASB issued a revision to FIN 46 (“FIN 46R”). FIN 46R defers the effective date of FIN 46 until the scope of the American Institution of Certified Public Accountants’ (“AICPA”) accounting and auditing guide is clarified. As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, the Company had no interest in an entity which would qualify as a variable interest entity. As a result, the adoption of this standard will not have a material impact on the accompanying financial statements.

      In May 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and Equity. SFAS No. 150 changes the accounting for certain financial instruments that, under previous guidance, could be classified as equity or “mezzanine” equity, including certain mandatorily redeemable instruments, by now requiring those instruments to be classified as liabilities in the statement of financial position. Further, SFAS No. 150 requires disclosure regarding the terms of those instruments and settlement alternatives. The Statement is effective for all interim periods beginning after June 15, 2003. The Company applied SFAS No. 150 to the shares subject to the put and call agreement issued to FS Acquisition, Inc., the successor-in-interest to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. for which redemption occurred on December 2, 2003. The adoption of this standard did not have a material impact on the Company’s other financial instruments.

      In May 2003, the Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) reached a consensus on EITF Issue No. 03-5, Applicability of AICPA Statement of Position 97-2 to Non-Software Deliverables in an Arrangement Containing More-Than-Incidental Software. This issue addresses revenue recognition for arrangements that include non-software deliverables, such as hardware, that are more than incidental to the products or services as a whole. The

F-13


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

consensus indicates that, if the software is not essential to the functionality of the non-software deliverable, the non-software deliverable is excluded from the scope of SOP 97-2. The Company expects that the impact of applying EITF 03-5 on its gross margin will depend on the timing and magnitude of its hardware sales. Under EITF 03-5, hardware revenue, previously bundled with software and recognized on a percentage of completion basis, may be recognized upon delivery of the hardware. In certain cases, this results in earlier recognition of revenue than when the revenue was recognized under the previous methodology. However, the completion of the check imaging arrangements are normally not of long duration, so this impact was not material.

      In December 2003, the SEC issued SAB No. 104, “Revenue Recognition.” SAB 104 revises or rescinds portions of the interpretive guidance included in Topic 13 of the codification of Staff Accounting Bulletins in order to make this interpretive guidance consistent with current authoritative accounting and auditing guidance and SEC rules and regulations. It also rescinds the Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements Frequently Asked Questions and Answers document issued in conjunction with Topic 13. Selected portions of that document have been incorporated into Topic 13. The adoption of SAB No. 104 in the fourth quarter of 2003 had no material impact on the Company’s financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 
Stock Compensation

      At December 31, 2003, the Company has stock compensation plans which are more fully described in Note 11 to the Financial Statements. The Company applies the intrinsic value recognition and measurement principles of APB Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees, and related interpretations and complies with the disclosure provisions of statement of SFAS No. 123, as amended by SFAS No. 148. Under APB 25, compensation expense is recognized over the vesting period to the extent that the fair market value of the underlying stock on the date of grant exceeds the exercise price of the employee stock option.

      The following table illustrates the effect on net income (loss) if the Company had applied the fair value recognition provisions of SFAS No. 123 to stock compensation:

                           
December 31,

2001 2002 2003



Net loss attributable to common stockholders, as reported
  $ (9,661,000 )   $ (2,897,000 )   $ (30,191,000 )
Add: Stock compensation expense included in reported net loss
    156,000       84,000       3,542,000  
Subtract: Total stock compensation expense determined under fair value method
    (1,704,000 )     (1,933,000 )     (5,630,000 )
     
     
     
 
Pro forma net loss
  $ (11,209,000 )   $ (4,746,000 )   $ (32,279,000 )
     
     
     
 
Reported net loss per share
                       
 
Basic
    (4.71 )     (1.18 )     (7.74 )
 
Diluted
    (4.71 )     (1.18 )     (7.74 )
Pro forma net loss per share
                       
 
Basic
    (5.47 )     (1.93 )     (8.27 )
 
Diluted
    (5.47 )     (1.93 )     (8.27 )

      The above pro forma results are not necessarily indicative of future pro forma results. Other disclosures required by SFAS No. 123 have been included in Note 11.

F-14


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

 
3. Investments in Marketable Securities

      The following table summarizes the Company’s available for sale investments:

                                 
December 31, 2003

Gross Gross
Amortized Unrealized Unrealized
Cost Gains Losses Fair Value




Corporate notes and bonds
  $ 7,835,000     $ 3,000     $ (31,000 )   $ 7,807,000  
Accrued investment income
                      221,000  
     
     
     
     
 
Total
  $ 7,835,000     $ 3,000     $ (31,000 )   $ 8,028,000  
     
     
     
     
 

      The Company’s investments in corporate notes and bonds are scheduled to mature in one to two years.

 
4. Acquisitions

      For the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, the Company entered into four acquisitions which are summarized below:

                                 
HNC
Sound Financial Liberty FiTech
Software Imagic Solutions Systems
(2001) (2001) (2002) (2003)




Tangible assets acquired
  $ 270,000     $ 2,198,000     $ 1,074,000     $ 4,006,000  
Purchased technology
    832,000       1,880,000       1,193,000       530,000  
In-process research and development
    447,000                    
Goodwill
    1,603,000       3,969,000       772,000       4,843,000  
Other intangibles
    196,000       80,000             6,700,000  
Liabilities assumed
    (383,000 )     (3,897,000 )     (986,000 )     (4,089,000 )
     
     
     
     
 
Purchase price
  $ 2,965,000     $ 4,230,000     $ 2,053,000     $ 11,990,000  
     
     
     
     
 

      Each of these acquisitions was accounted for as a purchase transaction. Accordingly, the purchase price was allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on estimates of fair value. The fair value of purchased technology was determined based on management’s valuation analysis utilizing an income approach that takes into account future cash flows. The excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the net assets acquired has been allocated to goodwill. The operating results of each business acquired have been included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements from respective dates of acquisition.

 
Sound Software

      On August 3, 2001, the Company completed the acquisition of Sound Software Development, Inc. (“Sound Software”) in exchange for $1,700,000 in cash, 80,472 shares of Series G Preferred Stock and 55,496 shares of common stock. Sound Software was acquired to expand the Company’s product offering to include loan origination software. In conjunction with the acquisition, the Company incurred approximately $113,000 of acquisition-related costs. The purchased technology related to this transaction is amortized over its estimated useful life of two to five years.

      The Company recorded a one-time write-off of $447,000 in August 2001 relating to the value of in-process research and development acquired as part of the purchase that had not yet reached technological feasibility and had no alternative future use. Accordingly, this amount was charged to expense in the consolidated statement of operations upon consummation of the acquisition. The value assigned to acquired in-process technology was determined by identifying any research projects at Sound Software for which

F-15


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

technological feasibility had not been established. One such project was identified and related to the upgrade of Sound Software’s mortgage product. The value of in-process research and development was determined based on management’s projected incremental cash flow estimated to be derived from the completed project discounted back to their present value using a discount rate of 20%. The discount rate was determined after consideration of the Company’s rate of return on equity capital, the weighted average return on invested capital and the risk associated with achieving anticipated sales related to the Sound Software technology acquired. The project was approximately 50% complete at the date of acquisition.

 
Imagic

      On December 14, 2001, the Company acquired Imagic Corporation (“Imagic”) in exchange for $1,830,000 in cash and 314,486 shares of Company common stock. The assumed liabilities included a note payable of $748,000 that was subsequently paid in full in January 2002. Imagic was acquired to expand the Company’s product offerings to include check imaging software and services. The acquisition was consummated on December 14, 2001, but for accounting purposes the transaction was treated as effective December 1, 2001. The activity during the intervening period was not material. In conjunction with the acquisition, the Company incurred approximately $120,000 of acquisition-related costs. The purchased technology related to this transaction is amortized over its estimated useful life of seven years.

      The financial information in the table below summarizes the combined results of operations of the Company and Imagic on a pro forma basis, as though the companies had been combined as of the beginning of the period being presented below. This pro forma financial information is presented for informational purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of the results of operations that would have been achieved had the acquisition actually taken place as of the beginning of the period being presented below.

         
Year Ended
December 31,
2001

Pro forma revenues
  $ 33,888,000  
Pro forma net loss available to common shareholders
    (11,089,000 )
Pro forma basic and diluted loss per share
    (3.87 )
 
HNC Financial Solutions

      During 2002, the Company acquired certain business operations from HNC Financial Solutions, Inc. (“HNC Financial Solutions”), a division of HNC Software Inc. (“HNC Software”) and an investor in the Company. These acquisitions were completed in March 2002 and October 2002.

      On March 29, 2002, the Company acquired fixed assets and intellectual property rights of “HNC Financial Solutions”, and assumed certain future software maintenance and support obligations in exchange for a $500,000 promissory note. Concurrent with the acquisition, the Company entered into a license and service agreement with HNC Financial Solutions for additional software. For these rights, the Company paid $564,000 in cash. Upon the acquisition of this business, the Company employed HNC Financial Solutions’ employees involved with this business, including sales, development, implementation and customer support personnel. This acquisition expanded the Company’s product offering to include financial accounting, asset/ liability, management and financial planning products.

      On October 31, 2002, the Company subsequently purchased from HNC Software the underlying intellectual property rights to the additional software that had been licensed in the March 2002 transaction, accounts receivable, fixed assets and related future software maintenance and support obligations in exchange for a $950,000 promissory note. Upon the acquisition of this business, the Company employed additional employees of HNC Financial Solutions involved with this business. The purchased technology related to the March 2002 and

F-16


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

October 2002 transaction is amortized on a straight-line basis over its estimated useful life of seven years. In conjunction with these transactions, the Company incurred approximately $39,000 of acquisition-related costs. This acquisition expanded the Company’s financial product offering to include profitability analysis.

 
Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc.

      On July 1, 2003, the Company acquired from Liberty Enterprises, Inc. (“Liberty”) substantially all of the operating assets, and assumed certain liabilities, of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. (“FiTech”), a provider of core processing software and related services for credit unions, for consideration of $11,704,000, consisting of $8,000,000 in cash, a promissory note in the amount of $1,904,000 and 133,195 shares of the Company’s common stock. In conjunction with the acquisition, the Company incurred approximately $286,000 of acquisition-related costs. The purchased technology related to this acquisition is being amortized over its estimated useful life of five years. The other intangible assets of $6,700,000, comprised of customer lists, are being amortized approximately $140,000 per quarter over their useful life of 12 years. Total amortization expense for the year ended December 31, 2003 was $279,000.

      The common stock issued to FiTech was subject to a put and call agreement whereby the Company had the right to purchase, and FiTech had the right to sell, the common stock to the other party at $13.51 per share, or approximately $1,800,000. On September 3, 2003, FS Acquisition, Inc., the successor-in-interest to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc., exercised its put right pursuant to this put and call agreement with respect to these shares. In December 2003, the Company purchased these 133,195 shares at a price of $13.51 per share, or an aggregate of $1,800,000.

      The financial information in the table below summarizes the combined results of operations of the Company and FiTech on a pro forma basis, as though the companies had been combined as of the beginning of the period being presented below. This pro forma financial information is presented for informational purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of the results of operations that would have been achieved had the acquisition actually taken place as of the beginning of the period being presented below.

                 
Year Ended December 31,

2002 2003


Pro forma revenues
  $ 60,775,000     $ 70,732,000  
Pro forma net loss available to common shareholders
    (5,819,000 )     (31,977,000 )
Pro forma per share — basic and diluted
    (2.37 )     (8.19 )

      Pro forma results of operations have not been presented for the acquisition of Sound Software and HNC Financial Solutions, as results of operations of the acquired businesses are not significant to the Company.

 
5. Fixed Assets
                 
December 31,

2002 2003


Computer equipment
  $ 7,340,000     $ 10,552,000  
Office furniture and equipment
    1,534,000       1,628,000  
Leasehold improvements
    941,000       1,020,000  
     
     
 
      9,815,000       13,200,000  
Less: accumulated depreciation
    (5,238,000 )     (7,700,000 )
     
     
 
    $ 4,577,000     $ 5,500,000  
     
     
 

      Depreciation and amortization expense was $1,284,000, $1,860,000 and $2,462,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

F-17


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

 
6. Capitalized Software Costs

      Capitalized software costs include completed technology acquired in business combinations. Additions to capitalized purchased technology costs were $2,712,000, $1,193,000 and $530,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003 respectively.

      Capitalized software costs also include costs associated with purchased third-party software. Additions to purchased third-party software were $320,000, $50,000, and $20,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, respectively. Capitalized software costs also include costs related to the development and purchase of internal-use software.

      A summary of the components of capitalized software costs is as follows:

                 
December 31,

2002 2003


Purchased technology
  $ 5,391,000     $ 5,921,000  
Internal use software
    1,746,000       1,746,000  
Purchased third-party software
    422,000       442,000  
     
     
 
      7,559,000       8,109,000  
Less: accumulated amortization
    (3,985,000 )     (5,145,000 )
     
     
 
    $ 3,574,000     $ 2,964,000  
     
     
 

      Amortization expense related to capitalized software costs was $1,738,000, $1,376,000, and $1,160,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

      Amortization expense for each of the next five years ended December 31 is expected to approximate:

           
2004
  $ 763,000  
2005
    616,000  
2006
    558,000  
2007
    529,000  
2008
    445,000  
     
 
 
Total
  $ 2,911,000  
     
 
 
7. Accrued Expenses
                 
December 31,

2002 2003


Compensation
  $ 2,506,000     $ 4,036,000  
Third party license fees
    741,000       2,027,000  
Accrued hardware purchases
    476,000       491,000  
Sales tax payable
    319,000       498,000  
Other
    776,000       1,316,000  
     
     
 
    $ 4,818,000     $ 8,368,000  
     
     
 

F-18


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

 
8. Long-Term Debt
 
Line of Credit and Equipment Term Loan

      On April 29, 2003, the Company secured a credit facility upon which it can draw an aggregate amount of $4,000,000. The facility provides for funding of up to $2,000,000 for an Equipment Term Loan and $2,000,000 for a Working Capital Line. The Equipment Term Loan bears interest at the greater of the prime rate plus 1% or 5.75%. The Working Capital Line bears interest at the greater of the prime rate plus 0.5% or 5.25%. The Company borrowed $1.7 million against the equipment portion of the facility, which was paid in full in December 2003 from the proceeds of the initial public offering. The facilities were collateralized by the tangible assets of the Company, excluding assets of its subsidiaries, and are subject to certain restrictive covenants. The Company terminated the facility in February 2004.

 
Long-Term Debt

      On December 14, 2001, the Company assumed a note payable in conjunction with the acquisition of Imagic of $748,000. The note was subsequently paid in full in January 2002.

      On March 29, 2002, the Company entered into a promissory note agreement for $500,000 with HNC Financial Solutions, a division of HNC Software and an investor in the Company, in conjunction with the acquisition of a business (see Note 4). The promissory note agreement specified an interest rate of 6% with the principal and interest balance due in full on March 29, 2004. The promissory note was collateralized by the purchased assets. This note was paid in full in December 2003 with proceeds from the initial public offering.

      On October 31, 2002, the Company entered into a promissory note agreement for $950,000 with HNC Software as part of an additional business acquisition. The promissory note agreement specified an interest rate of 4.5%, and that the principal balance and interest were due in full on October 31, 2005. The promissory note was collateralized by purchased assets. This promissory note was paid in full in December 2003 from proceeds from the Company’s initial public offering.

      On July 1, 2003, the Company entered into a promissory note agreement with FiTech as part of a business acquisition. The promissory note had an interest rate of 5% and was due in two installments, $1,704,000 on June 30, 2004 and $200,000 on December 31, 2004. In December 2003, this note was paid in full with proceeds from the Company’s initial public offering.

 
Long-term debt consists of the following:
                 
December 31,

2002 2003


Promissory note from related party bearing interest at 6% due in full March 29, 2004
  $ 500,000     $  
Promissory note from related party bearing interest at 4.5% due in full October 31, 2005; $750,000 is classified as current, as described above
    950,000        
     
     
 
Less current portion
    750,000        
     
     
 
Long-term debt
  $ 700,000     $  
     
     
 
 
9. Capital Lease Obligations

      In conjunction with the July 1, 2003 acquisition of FiTech, the Company assumed two capital leases for computer equipment. The capital leases are payable in monthly installments through March 2005 and have

F-19


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

incremental borrowing rates of 5.5 and 7.5 percent. Both capital lease obligations are collateralized by the equipment under these leases.

      Capital lease obligations are comprised of the following:

         
December 31,
2003

Computer equipment lease
  $ 459,000  
Less: current maturities
    (395,000 )
     
 
    $ 64,000  
     
 

      Future minimum payments under these leases are as follows:

           
Year Ended December 31,
       
 
2004
  $ 468,000  
 
2005
    78,000  
     
 
Total minimum lease payments
    546,000  
Amounts representing interest
    (87,000 )
     
 
Present value of minimum lease payments
  $ 459,000  
     
 

      The capitalized cost and accumulated amortization of assets acquired under capital leases included in the amounts presented above, are summarized as follows:

         
December 31,
2003

Computer equipment
  $ 711,000  
Accumulated amortization
    (203,000 )
     
 
    $ 508,000  
     
 

      Amortization expense for property and equipment under capital leases amounted to approximately $203,000 for the twelve months ended December 31, 2003.

 
10. Capital Stock and Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
 
Capital Stock

      As of December 31, 2003, the Company’s Certificate of Incorporation authorizes up to 95,000,000 shares of common stock.

      The Company has reserved shares of common stock as follows:

                 
December 31,

2002 2003


Conversion of preferred stock
    8,406,358        
Exercise of options
    5,082,194       7,965,786  
     
     
 
      13,488,552       7,965,786  
     
     
 

F-20


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

 
Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
                   
December 31,

2002 2003


Mandatorily Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock:
               
 
Series F preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 3,498,479 shares authorized, 3,358,371 issued and outstanding at $9.32 per share at December 31, 2002; (redemption value $31,300,000, liquidation preference $62,600,000)
  $ 31,100,000     $  
     
     
 
Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock:
               
 
Series A-1 preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 1,000,000 share authorized, 1,000,000 issued and outstanding at $1.50 per share at December 31, 2002; (no stated redemption value, liquidation preference $1,500,000)
    1,500,000        
 
Series A-2 preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 583,333 shares authorized, 583,333 issued and outstanding at $3.00 per share at December 31, 2002; (redemption value $500,000, liquidation preference $1,750,000)
    1,656,000        
 
Series B preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 1,736,250 shares authorized, 1,736,250 issued and outstanding at $3.00 per share at December 31, 2002; (redemption value $5,402,000, liquidation preference $5,209,000)
    5,363,000        
 
Series C preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 1,375,000 shares authorized, 1,361,111 issued and outstanding at $4.50 per share at December 31, 2002; (redemption value $6,333,000, liquidation preference $6,125,000)
    6,315,000        
 
Series D preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 1,250,000 shares authorized, 833,333 issued and outstanding at $6.00 per share at December 31, 2002; (redemption value and liquidation preference $5,000,000)
    4,978,000        
 
Series E preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 746,157 shares authorized, 746,157 issued and outstanding at $8.00 per share at December 31, 2002; (redemption and liquidation preference $5,969,000)
    5,945,000        
 
Series G preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 2,000,000 shares authorized, 80,472 issued and outstanding at $9.32 per share at December 31, 2002; (redemption and liquidation preference $750,000)
    723,000        
     
     
 
    $ 26,480,000     $  
     
     
 

      As of December 31, 2003 all warrants issued have been exercised or have expired.

      Concurrent with the closing of the Company’s initial public offering in December 2003, all preferred stock converted into shares of common stock.

      In April 2001, the Company issued a group of investors an additional 1,190,986 shares of Series F Mandatorily Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock at $9.32 per share for approximately $11,100,000.

      The conversion formula for the Series F preferred stock provided for adjustment of the Series F preferred stock conversion price in the event that the Company’s initial public offering price was less than $27.03 per share. Holders of Series F preferred stock received shares of common stock from the initial public offering with an aggregate value of $62,600,000. The recorded value of Series F preferred stock was $31,100,000 and as a result, upon the closing of the initial public offering, the Company recorded an accretion charge of $31,500,000 in stockholders’ equity (deficit). This accretion charge resulted in a non-cash deduction from income attributable to holders of common stock and a deduction in related earnings per share.

F-21


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      In August 2001, the Company issued 80,472 shares of Series G Preferred Stock as consideration in the purchase of certain assets and liabilities of Sound Software Development, Inc. (Note 4).

 
Rights and Preferences of Preferred Stock

      The Series C, Series D and Series E had similar redemption features as the Series B. The rights of CII and the holders of Series B, Series C, Series D, Series E and Series F Preferred Stock to redeem their shares if the Company fails to maintain a Connecticut presence, terminated upon the closing of the Company’s initial public offering.

      Each share of the Series A-1, Series A-2, Series B, Series C, Series D, Series E, Series F and Series G was convertible at any time into shares of common stock as determined by dividing the original issuance price for such series by the conversion price in effect at the time of conversion. The initial conversion price was the original issuance price, subject to certain antidilution provisions, including the reverse stock split which was effected prior to the closing of the offering.

      The holders of preferred stock were entitled to receive non-cumulative cash dividends when and as declared by the Board of Directors and have similar voting rights as common stockholders in addition to certain other defined voting rights. In the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation of the Company, including change of control, the holders of Series A-1, Series A-2, Series B, Series C, Series D, Series E, Series F and Series G Preferred Stock would have been entitled to all unpaid dividends at the time of liquidation and $1.50, $3.00, $3.00, $4.50, $6.00, $8.00, $18.64 and $9.32, respectively, per share as a liquidating distribution prior to any liquidating distribution to the common stockholders. Upon the completion of the required per share distribution, the remaining assets would have been distributed pro rata among the holders of preferred stock and common stock based on the number of shares of common stock held by each, assuming conversion of all preferred stock.

 
11. Stock Option Plans
 
1994 Stock Option Plan

      The Company established the 1994 Stock Option Plan (the “1994 Plan”) for employees, officers, directors, and consultants to the Company under which the Board of Directors granted incentive stock options and non-qualified stock options. Incentive stock options were granted at the fair value of the Common Stock at the time of grant, as determined by the Board of Directors. Generally, incentive stock options vest 25% on the first anniversary of the date of grant and then ratably on a monthly basis over the subsequent three years. Non-qualified stock options have a vesting period as determined by the Board of Directors generally vesting 25% on the first anniversary of the date of grant and then ratably on a monthly basis over the subsequent three years. The stock options are exercisable over a period of ten years from the date of grant.

      The Company’s 1994 Plan was amended by the Board of Directors in March 2000 to provide for acceleration of vesting upon an acquisition event, as defined, subject to revision by the Board of Directors. The maximum number of shares that were issuable under the 1994 Plan was 2,068,965. Upon the closing of the initial public offering in December 2003 no further option grants are expected to be made under the 1994 Plan.

 
2000 Stock Incentive Plan

      The Company’s 2000 Stock Incentive Plan (the “2000 Plan”) was adopted by the Board of Directors and approved by the stockholders in December 2000. A maximum of 3,790,220 shares of common stock are issuable under the plan. This maximum number of 3,790,220 shares increases each January 1 during the term of the plan by an additional number of shares of common stock equal to 5% of the total number of shares of common stock issued and outstanding as of the close of business on the preceding December 31. An amendment to the 2000 Plan was adopted by the Board of Directors in August 2003 and approved by the stockholders in October 2003 to

F-22


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

limit the aggregate number of shares of common stock issuable under the plan to 10,344,827 shares, notwithstanding the annual increase in the number of shares issuable under the plan. No participant in this plan may in any year be granted stock options or awards with respect to more than 344,827 shares of common stock.

      Under the 2000 Plan, in May 2003, the Company granted 680,530 shares of restricted common stock to its officers, directors and certain key employees which vest at the end of seven years or would vest immediately upon a change in control or initial public offering. The weighted average fair value of restricted stock granted was $4.81 at the time of grant. Upon issuance of the restricted stock, deferred compensation equivalent to the $3,276,000 market value at the date of grant was charged to shareholders’ equity and subsequently amortized over seven years. Upon the closing of the Company’s initial public offering in December 2003, vesting was automatically accelerated and the Company recorded additional compensation expense of $3,003,000 and employer tax expense of approximately $168,000 related to the restricted stock in the fourth quarter of 2003.

      The 2000 Plan is administered by the compensation committee of the Board of Directors, which has the authority to determine which individuals are eligible to receive options or restricted stock awards, and the terms of those options or awards. The exercise price of non-qualified stock options granted under this plan may not be less than 85% of the fair market value of a share of common stock on the date of grant, or 100%, in the case of incentive stock options. The options become exercisable at such time or times as are determined by the compensation committee and expire after a specified period that may not exceed ten years.

      Upon the acquisition of 50% or more of the Company’s outstanding common stock pursuant to a hostile tender offer, each option granted to an officer of the Company, if it has been outstanding for at least six months, will automatically be canceled in exchange for a cash distribution to the officer based upon the difference between the tender offer price and the exercise price of the option.

      In the event the Company is acquired, vesting of options and restricted stock awards granted under the 2000 Plan will accelerate to the extent that the options or the Company’s repurchase rights with respect to restricted stock awards are not assumed by or assigned to the acquiring entity. The compensation committee also has discretion to provide for accelerated vesting of options and restricted stock awards upon the occurrence of certain changes in control. Accelerated vesting may be conditioned upon subsequent termination of the affected optionee’s service.

      With the consent of an option holder, the compensation committee can cancel that holder’s options and replace them with new options for the same or a different number of shares having an exercise price based upon the fair market value of the Company’s common stock on the new grant date. The Company has not canceled and reissued any options as of December 31, 2003.

      The Company’s board of directors may amend or modify the 2000 Plan at any time subject to the rights of holders of outstanding options. This plan will terminate on December 20, 2010.

 
2003 Stock Incentive Plan

      The Company’s 2003 Stock Incentive Plan (the “2003 Plan”) was adopted by the Board of Directors in August 2003 and approved by the stockholders in October 2003. This plan provides for the grant of incentive stock options, nonqualified stock options and restricted stock awards to the Company’s employees, officers, directors, consultants and advisors. A maximum of 2,068,965 shares of common stock will be reserved for issuance under this plan. No participant in this plan may in any year be granted stock options or awards with respect to more than 344,827 shares of common stock.

      The 2003 Plan will be administered by the Board of Directors, which has the authority to determine which individuals are eligible to receive options or restricted stock awards and the terms of those options or awards.

      Upon the acquisition of 50% or more of the Company’s outstanding common stock pursuant to a hostile tender offer, each option granted to an officer of the Company, if it has been outstanding for at least six

F-23


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

months, will automatically be canceled in exchange for a cash distribution to the officer based upon the difference between the tender offer price and the exercise price of the option.

      In the event the Company is acquired or the Company’s common stock is exchanged for other consideration, vesting of options and restricted stock awards granted under the 2003 Stock Incentive Plan will accelerate to the extent that the options or the Company’s repurchase rights with respect to restricted stock awards are not assumed by or assigned to the acquiring entity. The Board of Directors can additionally cause any options or restricted stock awards to become fully exercisable at any other time. With the consent of an option holder, the Board of Directors can cancel that holder’s options and replace them with new options for the same or a different number of shares having an exercise price based upon the fair market value of the Company’s common stock on the new grant date.

      The Board of Directors may amend or modify the 2003 Plan at any time subject to the rights of holders of outstanding options. This plan will terminate in August 2013. As of December 31, 2003, no options or awards were issued pursuant to the 2003 Plan.

 
2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan

      The Company’s 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the “2003 ESPP”) was adopted by the Board of Directors in August 2003 and approved by the stockholders in October 2003. The purchase plan authorizes the issuance of up to a total of 1,379,310 shares of the Company’s common stock to participating employees through payroll deductions. The plan is intended to qualify as an “employee stock purchase plan” under Section 423 of the Internal Revenue Code.

      Employees are eligible to participate in the purchase plan at the beginning of each six-month offering period. Employees may elect to withhold up to 10% of their compensation to purchase shares of the Company’s common stock at a price equal to 85% of the fair market value of the stock on the first and last day of the offering period, whichever is lower. As of December 31, 2003, no shares or awards were issued pursuant to the 2003 ESPP.

      A summary of stock option activity under the 1994 Plan, 2000 Plan and 2003 Plan is as follows.

                   
Weighted Average
Number of Shares Exercise Price


Outstanding at December 31, 2000
    1,394,923     $ 3.90  
 
Granted
    926,858       7.25  
 
Canceled
    (120,708 )     6.77  
 
Exercised
    (12,071 )     0.85  
     
     
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2001
    2,189,002       5.18  
 
Granted
    491,886       7.25  
 
Canceled
    (288,683 )     6.57  
 
Exercised
    (88,163 )     0.87  
     
     
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2002
    2,304,042       5.60  
 
Granted
    663,737       4.32  
 
Canceled
    (49,545 )     6.35  
 
Exercised
    (7,942 )     1.35  
     
     
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2003
    2,910,292     $ 5.32  
     
     
 

F-24


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      The following table summarizes information regarding stock options granted during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003:

                           
Weighted Average
SFAS 123
Numbers of Weighted Average Fair Value
Options Granted Exercise Price at Grant Date



2001
                       
 
Options granted with an exercise price equal to market value
    926,858     $ 7.25     $ 4.85  
2002
                       
 
Options granted with an exercise price greater than market value
    491,886       7.25       1.39  
2003
                       
 
Options granted with an exercise price equal to market value
    88,959       13.05       8.71  
 
Options granted with an exercise price greater than market value
    11,019       7.25       1.89  
 
Options granted with an exercise price less than market value
    563,759       2.89       4.58  

      As of December 31, 2002 and 2003, there were 1,291,789 and 1,780,740 shares exercisable at a weighted average exercise price of $4.45 and $5.16, respectively.

      The following table summarizes additional information about stock options outstanding at December 31, 2003:

                                 
Options Outstanding Options Exercisable


Number Weighted Average
Outstanding at Remaining Number
December 31, Contractual Life Weighted Average Exercisable at
Range of Exercise Price 2003 in Years Exercise Price December 31, 2003





$0.00-2.28
    386,082       1.50     $ 0.33       386,082  
2.28-4.56
    635,631       8.60       3.03       81,173  
4.56-6.83
    546,130       5.80       5.80       546,130  
6.83-9.11
    1,253,490       7.50       7.26       767,355  
11.39-13.67
    88,959       9.90       13.05        
     
     
     
     
 
      2,910,292       6.70     $ 5.32       1,780,740  
     
     
     
     
 

      The weighted average SFAS No. 123 fair value at grant date was $4.85, $1.39 and $5.09 for options granted in the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

      The fair value of each option grant is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions used for options granted during the applicable period:

                         
2001 2002 2003



Risk free interest rate
    4.89 %     3.32 %     2.99 %
Expected dividend yield
    None       None       None  
Expected life of option
    6  years       6  years       6  years  
Expected volatility
    71 %     72 %     74 %

F-25


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      The fair value method requires the input of highly subjective assumptions, including expected stock price volatility. Changes in the subjective input assumptions can materially affect the fair value estimate. See Note 2 for additional disclosures required by SFAS No. 123 and SFAS No. 148.

      The Company has issued stock options with an exercise price less than the then-current fair market value of common stock. Compensation expense related to such option grants is being recognized ratably over the four-year vesting period and totaled $156,000, $84,000 and $266,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, respectively. Accrued compensation of $147,000 and $60,000 was reversed against Additional Paid-In Capital related to expiration of vested stock options for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

 
12. 401(k) Plan

      The Company has established a voluntary 401(k) plan in which all full-time employees are eligible to participate. The Company provides matching contributions of 25% of the first four percent of the employee’s compensation that is deferred under the plan which is funded on an annual basis. Eligible employees who elect to participate in the 401(k) plan are generally vested in the Company’s matching contributions after three years of service. Company contributions for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003 were $114,000, $130,000, and $186,000, respectively.

 
13. Commitments and Contingencies

      At December 31, 2003, the Company was committed under facility and various other operating leases, which expire at various dates through 2005. Minimum future lease payments under non-cancelable leases with a remaining term of greater than one year at December 31, 2003 are approximately as follows:

         
2004
  $ 1,365,000  
2005
    917,000  
2006
    2,000  
     
 
Total minimum obligations
  $ 2,284,000  
     
 

      Rent expense under operating leases was $977,000, $1,072,000 and $1,417,000 for the years ended December 2001, 2002 and 2003, respectively. The Company recognizes rent expense on a straight-line basis relating to a five-year lease agreement with escalating payment terms expiring April 2005, which results in accrued rent expense of $119,000 and $130,000 as of December 31, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

      In May 2002, the Company entered into an employment agreement with its Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”). Under this agreement, which has a three-year term, the Company agreed to pay the CEO an annual base salary of $321,200 and a bonus based on the achievement of certain performance targets. The agreement provides for severance pay if employment terminates without cause or good reason equal to a year’s salary and the full amount of the CEO’s target bonus.

 
Legal Proceedings

      The Company is from time to time a party to legal proceedings which arise in the normal course of business. The Company is not currently involved in any material litigation, the outcome of which would, in management’s judgment based on information currently available, have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations or financial condition, nor is management aware of any such litigation.

      In November 2000, a small consulting firm, Enserv, Inc. (“Enserv”), filed a complaint against the Company, alleging that the Company breached the terms of the value-added reseller agreement. The consulting firm alleged damages of approximately $6,000,000. In October 2003, the Company and Enserv

F-26


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

settled this complaint. Pursuant to the settlement, which includes mutual releases of the parties: (1) the Company made a payment to Enserv in the amount of $233,333; and (2) the Company and Enserv entered into a consulting agreement whereby Enserv is obligated to provide technical consulting services to the Company for two years for which Enserv will be paid $133,333 per year. The Company had earlier provided a $50,000 reserve for this matter in October 2003 and recorded an additional settlement expense of $183,333. The Company will record the $266,666 consulting expense ratably during the twenty-four months following execution of the settlement documents as Enserv performs its obligations under the consulting agreement. The Company has the right to cancel the consulting agreement if Enserv does not perform under the terms of the agreement.

 
14. Income Taxes

      The income tax provision (benefit) consists of the following:

                           
Year Ended December 31,

2001 2002 2003



Current:
                       
 
Federal
  $     $     $ 72,000  
 
State
    (250,000 )     32,000       69,000  
Deferred:
                       
 
Federal
                81,000  
 
State
                12,000  
     
     
     
 
Total
  $ (250,000 )   $ 32,000     $ 234,000  
     
     
     
 

      The components of the Company’s deferred income taxes at December 31, 2002 and 2003 are as follows:

                   
Year Ended December 31,

2002 2003


Gross deferred tax asset
               
 
Net operating loss carryforwards
  $ 14,725,000     $ 16,480,000  
 
Research and development carryforwards
    1,059,000       868,000  
 
State credits — non research and development
    280,000       405,000  
 
Stock compensation expense
    164,000       197,000  
 
Deferred revenue
    1,429,000       1,507,000  
 
Accrued expenses
    86,000       301,000  
 
Accounts receivable
    163,000       164,000  
 
Accelerated depreciation
          38,000  
 
Other
    66,000       162,000  
     
     
 
Deferred tax assets, gross
    17,972,000       20,122,000  
Less: Valuation allowance
    (17,305,000 )     (19,955,000 )
     
     
 
Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance
    667,000       167,000  
 
Gross deferred tax liabilities
               
 
Intangible assets
    502,000       260,000  
 
Accelerated depreciation
    165,000        
     
     
 
      667,000       260,000  
     
     
 
Net deferred tax asset (liability)
  $     $ (93,000 )
     
     
 

F-27


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      The deferred tax liability at December 31, 2003 has been classified as other long-term liabilities in the accompanying balance sheet.

      The valuation allowance increased by $2,650,000 during 2003 of which $513,000 is attributable to the current operations and $3,163,000 is attributable to the deferred tax benefit associated with the vesting of 680,530 of restricted stock previously issued under the Company’s 2000 Stock Incentive Plan, and thus was charged to paid in capital. A tax benefit of $72,000 was recorded to additional paid-in capital in 2003 relating to the transaction.

      Realization of the net deferred tax asset is dependent on the Company generating sufficient taxable income prior to the expiration of the loss carryforwards and general business credits, where applicable. The Company has provided a valuation allowance for the full amount of the deferred tax asset, since management has not determined that these future benefits will more likely than not be realized as of December 31, 2003. The valuation allowance could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are realized.

      The difference between the Company’s “expected” tax expense as computed by applying the U.S. Federal corporate income tax rate of 34% to income (loss) before taxes are as follows:

                 
2002 2003


Computed “expected” tax expense (benefit)
  $ (974,000 )   $ 525,000  
State income taxes, net of federal tax benefit
    (309,000 )     100,000  
Non-deductible expenses
    50,000       67,000  
Deferred compensation
          78,000  
Research and development tax credit
    (100,000 )      
Change in valuation allowance
    1,192,000       (513,000 )
Decrease in prior expected R&D tax credit
    106,000        
Other
    67,000       (23,000 )
     
     
 
Income tax expense
  $ 32,000     $ 234,000  
     
     
 
Computed “expected” tax expense (benefit)
    34.0 %     34.0 %
State income taxes, net of federal tax benefit
    10.8 %     6.5 %
Non-deductible expenses
    (1.7 )%     4.3 %
Deferred compensation
          5.1 %
Research and development tax credit
    3.5 %      
Change in valuation allowance
    (41.6 )%     (33.2 )%
Decrease in prior expected R&D tax credit
    (3.7 )%      
Other
    (2.3 )%     (1.5 )%
     
     
 
Income tax expense (benefit)
    (1.1 )%     15.2 %
     
     
 

      At December 31, 2003, the Company had approximately $43,206,000 of federal net operating loss carryforwards that begin expiring in 2007 and had approximately $35,793,000 of state net operating loss carryforwards, which begin to expire in 2004. At December 31, 2003, the Company had approximately $513,000 of federal research and development credit carryforwards that begin to expire in 2007, and approximately $355,000 of state research and development carryforwards with an unlimited carryforward period, and approximately $405,000 of state non-research and development credit carryforwards which begin to expire in 2004.

F-28


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      As defined in the Internal Revenue Code, certain ownership changes limit the annual utilization of federal net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards. The Company experienced such an ownership change in December 1995 which limits approximately $3,200,000 of federal net operating loss carryforwards and $149,000 of research tax credits to a $307,000 annual Section 382 limitation. Management believes that the initial public offering did not cause any additional Section 382 limitation.

 
15. Related Parties

      A director of the Company is a member of management at one of the Company’s clients. For the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, revenues from the client were $1,240,000, $885,000, and $599,000, respectively. As of December 31, 2002 and 2003, $5,000 and $0 was due from this client, respectively. Additionally, the Company holds its main operating bank account with this client.

      On September 30, 2003, the Company amended and restated its existing software license agreement (see Note 16) with BISYS, a subsidiary of the BISYS Group, Inc., a holder of the Company’s common stock. This agreement amended and restated a prior software license and marketing and distribution agreement between the Company and BISYS. The Group President, Information Services of The BISYS Group, Inc. was a member of the Company’s Board of Directors through November 2003. For the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, revenues of $1,336,000, $2,919,000 and $5,837,000 were recognized under these agreements, respectively. As of December 31, 2002 and 2003, $603,000 and $784,000, respectively, were due from BISYS under the marketing and distribution agreement.

      During 2002, the Company acquired certain assets and intellectual property rights from HNC Software (see Note 4), who is also a holder of the Company’s common stock. The Vice President of Corporate Development of Fair Isaac Corporation, the successor-in-interest to HNC Software Inc., was a member of the Board of Directors of the Company through November 2003.

 
16. Amended Reseller Agreements

      On September 30, 2003, the Company amended and restated its existing software license agreement with BISYS, one of its resellers. Effective September 1, 2003, BISYS became the Company’s national outsourcing reseller to provide data processing services to banks and thrifts in the United States using the Company’s The Complete Banking Solution software through BISYS’ outsourcing centers. In addition, BISYS will offer the Company’s complementary products and services, which will be BISYS’ exclusive offering for such products and services, to those banks and thrifts purchasing TotalCS. The agreement has a term of five years, with an option to renew for another five years by mutual consent or at BISYS’ option.

      Under the terms of the agreement, BISYS pays the Company non-refundable minimum license fees related to the achievement of certain minimum sales requirements for both unit sales and license fees. BISYS also pays an annual maintenance fee for each customer contract that BISYS maintains that uses the Company’s products or services. The Company has agreed not to compete with BISYS for the sale of data processing services using The Complete Banking Solution software on an outsourced basis to banks and thrifts in the United States, except in certain limited circumstances. The Company will also not provide any third-party reseller of The Complete Banking Solution software in the United States with more favorable prices and pricing terms, in the aggregate, than are provided to BISYS under the agreement. If, after September 30, 2005, BISYS fails to achieve the minimum sales requirements, the Company may terminate the limited non-compete and favorable price and pricing term obligations, but the Company will no longer be entitled to receive minimum license fee payments from BISYS. BISYS also has the right to terminate the minimum payment requirements after September 30, 2005 if it fails to achieve the minimum sales requirements, but BISYS will have an obligation for additional non-refundable minimum license fees in order to exercise this right. BISYS’ termination of the minimum payment requirements will automatically cancel the limited non-

F-29


Table of Contents

OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

compete and favorable price and pricing term obligations. The Company has also agreed not to enter into a similar reseller agreement with any one of six named BISYS competitors before March 1, 2005.

      The Company has recorded $2,716,000 in revenue from BISYS in 2003 related to licenses fees under the new arrangement.

      On May 15, 2003, the Company amended its existing software license agreement with its primary regional reseller. This amendment removes the maximum fee limit from the original agreement for sales after December 9, 2002, and provides for payments to the Company upon both contract signing and the conversion of the end user financial institution.

 
17. Subsequent Event

      On February 24, 2004, the Company acquired the stock of Maxxar Corporation for cash consideration of $6.5 million. In connection with the acquisition, the Company incurred approximately $175,000 of acquisition related costs. This acquisition will be recorded under the purchase method with the total consideration allocated to the fair value of assets acquired and goodwill. This acquisition expanded the Company’s complementary product offerings to include a comprehensive suite of interactive voice solutions and computer telephony integration products.

 
18. Selected Quarterly Financial Data (Unaudited)
                                   
First Quarter Second Quarter Third Quarter Fourth Quarter




2002
                               
 
Revenue
  $ 9,309,000     $ 10,676,000     $ 11,318,000     $ 13,042,000  
 
Gross Profit
    4,237,000       5,681,000       5,721,000       7,124,000  
 
Income (loss) from operations
    (2,289,000 )     (1,059,000 )     (227,000 )     565,000  
 
Net income (loss)
    (2,255,000 )     (1,034,000 )     (219,000 )     611,000  
 
Basic income (loss) per share
    (0.94 )     (0.42 )     (0.09 )     0.25  
 
Diluted income (loss) per share
    (0.94 )     (0.42 )     (0.09 )     0.06  
2003
                               
 
Revenue
  $ 12,340,000     $ 13,601,000     $ 17,427,000     $ 20,484,000  
 
Gross Profit
    6,659,000       7,572,000       9,023,000       11,717,000  
 
Income (loss) from operations
    95,000       864,000       915,000       (374,000 )
 
Net income (loss)
    77,000       790,000       806,000       (364,000 )
 
Net income (loss) attributable to common stockholders
    77,000       790,000       806,000       (31,864,000 )
 
Basic income (loss) per share
    0.03       0.32       0.32       (3.94 )
 
Diluted income (loss) per share
    0.01       0.08       0.08       (3.94 )

      As described in Note 4, the Company has acquired two businesses during the periods above. These acquisitions have affected the Company’s revenues, results of operations, and financial conditions. The operating results of each business acquired have been included in the Company’s financial statements from the respective dates of acquisition.

F-30


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders

of Open Solutions Inc.:

      In our opinion, the accompanying balance sheets and the related statements of operations and accumulated deficit and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. (a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.) at December 31, 2001, December 31, 2002 and June 30, 2003, and the results of its operations and cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2001, December 31, 2002 and for the six months ended June 30, 2003 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. These financial statements are the responsibility of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc.’s management; our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits of these statements in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America, which require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

      As discussed in Notes 3 and 6 to the financial statements, Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, effective January 1, 2002.

  PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
 
  /s/ PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS LLP
Hartford, Connecticut
August 18, 2003

F-31


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.

(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
BALANCE SHEETS
December 31, 2001, December 31, 2002 and June 30, 2003
                             
December 31, December 31, June 30,
2001 2002 2003



(in thousands of dollars)
Assets
                       
Current assets
                       
 
Accounts receivable, net
  $ 3,337     $ 3,494     $ 1,027  
 
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
    284       431       377  
     
     
     
 
   
Total current assets
    3,621       3,925       1,404  
     
     
     
 
Fixed assets, net
    1,509       1,048       960  
Capitalized software costs, net
    1,156       1,305       1,284  
Goodwill, net
    6,843       6,843       6,843  
Other intangible assets, net
    5,613       6,152       5,880  
     
     
     
 
   
Total assets
  $ 18,742     $ 19,273     $ 16,371  
     
     
     
 
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
                       
Current liabilities
                       
 
Capital lease obligations, current portion
  $ 340     $ 331     $ 408  
 
Long-term debt, current portion
                241  
 
Accounts payable
    257       702       183  
 
Accrued expenses
    533       780       597  
 
Deferred revenue, current portion
    3,419       3,937       3,303  
     
     
     
 
   
Total current liabilities
    4,549       5,750       4,732  
     
     
     
 
Deferred revenue, less current portion
    449       829       635  
Capital lease obligations, less current portion
    695       364       259  
Long-term debt, less current portion
    241       391       150  
Advances from Liberty
    6,748       9,105       9,844  
     
     
     
 
   
Total liabilities
    12,682       16,439       15,620  
     
     
     
 
Commitments and contingencies (Note 11)
                       
Common stock
    1       1       1  
Additional paid-in capital
    9,696       9,696       9,696  
Accumulated deficit
    (3,637 )     (6,863 )     (8,946 )
     
     
     
 
   
Total stockholders’ equity
    6,060       2,834       751  
     
     
     
 
   
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
  $ 18,742     $ 19,273     $ 16,371  
     
     
     
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

F-32


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.

(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND ACCUMULATED DEFICIT
Years Ended December 31, 2001, and 2002 and
Six Months Ended June 30, 2002 (unaudited) and 2003
                                     
Years Ended Six Months Ended
December 31, June 30,


2001 2002 2002 2003




(unaudited)
(in thousands of dollars)
Revenues
                               
 
Software license and services
  $ 8,101     $ 10,146     $ 5,322     $ 5,654  
 
Hardware
    3,656       6,284       2,784       1,226  
     
     
     
     
 
   
Total revenues
    11,757       16,430       8,106       6,880  
Cost of revenues
                               
 
Software license and services
    3,020       6,131       2,969       3,302  
 
Hardware
    2,956       5,311       2,381       1,175  
     
     
     
     
 
   
Total cost of revenues
    5,976       11,442       5,350       4,477  
     
     
     
     
 
 
Gross margin
    5,781       4,988       2,756       2,403  
Operating expenses
                               
 
Sales and marketing
    1,382       2,001       981       1,223  
 
Product development
    1,057       491       266       184  
 
General and administrative
    6,063       5,325       3,000       2,802  
     
     
     
     
 
   
Total operating expenses
    8,502       7,817       4,247       4,209  
     
     
     
     
 
Loss from operations
    (2,721 )     (2,829 )     (1,491 )     (1,806 )
 
Interest expense
    (257 )     (397 )     (159 )     (277 )
     
     
     
     
 
Net loss
    (2,978 )     (3,226 )     (1,650 )     (2,083 )
Accumulated deficit, beginning of period
    (659 )     (3,637 )     (3,637 )     (6,863 )
     
     
     
     
 
Accumulated deficit, end of period
  $ (3,637 )   $ (6,863 )   $ (5,287 )   $ (8,946 )
     
     
     
     
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

F-33


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.

(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
Years Ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 and
Six Months Ended June 30, 2002 (unaudited) and 2003
                                         
Year Ended Six Months Ended
December 31, June 30,


2001 2002 2002 2003




(unaudited)
(in thousands of dollars)
Cash flows from operating activities
                               
 
Net loss
  $ (2,978 )   $ (3,226 )   $ (1,650 )   $ (2,083 )
     
     
     
     
 
 
Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash (used in) provided by operating activities
                               
   
Depreciation and amortization
    1,352       1,475       811       816  
   
Changes in operating assets and liabilities, excluding effects from acquisition:
                               
     
Accounts receivable
    (569 )     (157 )     2,297       2,467  
     
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
    242       (147 )     (1 )     54  
     
Accounts payable and accrued expenses
    (360 )     666       (186 )     (702 )
     
Deferred revenue
    (367 )     898       (600 )     (828 )
     
     
     
     
 
       
Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities
    (2,680 )     (491 )     671       (276 )
     
     
     
     
 
Cash flows from investing activities
                               
 
Purchases of fixed assets
    (374 )     (93 )     (26 )     (32 )
 
Capitalized software
    (1,252 )     (583 )     (279 )     (236 )
 
Business acquisition
          (850 )            
     
     
     
     
 
       
Net cash used in investing activities
    (1,626 )     (1,526 )     (305 )     (268 )
     
     
     
     
 
Cash flows from financing activities
                               
 
Repayments of capital lease
    (251 )     (340 )     (167 )     (198 )
 
Intercompany advances (repayments)
    4,757       2,357       (199 )     742  
 
Repayment of note payable
    (200 )                  
     
     
     
     
 
       
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    4,306       2,017       (366 )     544  
     
     
     
     
 
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
                       
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period
                       
     
     
     
     
 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period
  $     $     $     $  
     
     
     
     
 
Supplemental disclosures
                               
 
Cash paid for interest
  $ 4     $ 26     $ 9     $ 20  

See non-cash financing transactions at Note 4 and 9

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements.

F-34


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.

(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
December 31, 2001, December 31, 2002 and June 30, 2003

1.     Description of Business

      Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc., or FiTech, was founded in 1977 and is based in Atlanta, Georgia. FiTech is a provider of credit union core software and processing services. FiTech’s software, Manager Gold, enables credit unions to manage back-office core accounting operations, customer interaction processes, and data processing.

      Through June 30, 2003, FiTech was a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc., or Liberty, a Minneapolis, Minnesota provider of payment products, marketing services, and technology solutions to credit unions based in the United States of America. Liberty acquired FiTech in August 2000. On July 1, 2003, Open Solutions Inc. (“Open Solutions”) purchased substantially all of the operating assets and assumed certain liabilities of FiTech from Liberty for a purchase price of $11,703,000, comprised of $8,000,000 in cash, $1,903,000 in a note payable to FiTech, and 193,133 shares of Open Solutions’ common stock.

2.     Basis of Presentation

      During the periods presented, FiTech operated as a subsidiary of Liberty and shared certain resources with Liberty. The financial statements of FiTech have been derived from the financial statements and accounting records of Liberty using historical results of operations and historical basis of assets and liabilities. FiTech’s management believes the assumptions underlying the combined financial statements are reasonable. However, the financial statements included herein may not necessarily reflect FiTech’s results of operations, financial position and cash flows in the future or its results of operations, financial position and cash flows had FiTech operated as a stand-alone entity during the periods presented.

      The financial statements include allocations of certain Liberty expenses. Corporate expense allocations have been primarily charged based on the ratio of FiTech’s head count or revenue to Liberty’s aggregate consolidated head count or revenue, depending on the nature of the expense. FiTech’s allocated expenses primarily include administrative expenses such as accounting and finance services, human resources, corporate marketing, and information technology. These expenses totaled $1,314,000 and $1,531,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002, and $766,000 (unaudited) and $727,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, respectively, and are reflected in general and administrative expenses in the accompanying financial statements. FiTech’s management believes the amount of these services are a reasonable representation of the services performed for or benefited by FiTech.

      Liberty uses a centralized approach to cash management and the financing of its operations. Cash deposits from FiTech are transferred to Liberty and cash disbursements made by FiTech are funded by Liberty. The net balance of such deposits and disbursements is reflected in the balance sheet as Advances from Liberty. As a result, Liberty’s cash, cash equivalents and debt at the corporate level have not been allocated to FiTech in the financial statements.

      FiTech’s financial statements include an interest expense allocation totaling $236,000 and $347,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002, and $139,000 (unaudited) and $240,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, respectively. Interest expense has been allocated based on an assumed incremental borrowing rate applied to the average monthly Advances from Liberty balance during each period. The associated incremental borrowing rate was 7.5 percent for the year ended December 31, 2001 and 5.5 percent for all periods thereafter. The Advances from Liberty do not necessarily reflect the level of indebtedness FiTech would assume on a stand-alone basis, and the assumed incremental borrowing rate does not necessarily reflect the interest rate of FiTech on a stand-alone basis. FiTech’s management believes these are reasonable estimates of the cost of financing FiTech’s assets and operations based on the nature of the business and the risks and expected returns of similar debt securities. On a stand-alone basis, FiTech may not

F-35


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

be able to obtain financing at interest rates similar to those assumed above. Accordingly, FiTech’s interest expense as a stand-alone entity may be different than that reflected in the financial statements.

      There is no stated maturity date for the Advances from Liberty balance. As a result of the historical losses of FiTech and the expected continuation of negative operating cash flow, the Advances from Liberty are not expected to be repaid within the next year. In connection with the acquisition, the Advances from Liberty were not assumed by Open Solutions.

3.     Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

 
      Use of Estimates

      The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 
      Unaudited Interim Financial Statements

      The unaudited financial statements for the six months ended June 30, 2002 have been prepared on the same basis as the audited financial statements and, in the opinion of FiTech’s management, contain all adjustments, consisting of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of its results of operations and cash flows. Results for the six months ended June 30, 2002 are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for the entire fiscal year 2002 or any other interim period.

 
Accounts Receivable

      Accounts receivables are presented net of the allowance for doubtful accounts. The allowance is based on historical experience of credit losses and a periodic evaluation of accounts receivable balances outstanding. As of December 31, 2001 and 2002 and June 30, 2003, the allowance for doubtful accounts was $215,000, $53,000 and $50,000, respectively. FiTech did not have significant bad debt expense during the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 and the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003.

 
Fixed Assets

      Fixed assets are stated at cost and are depreciated using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets: computer software and hardware over three years and furniture and fixtures over ten years. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the term of the lease or the useful life of the asset.

 
      Long-Lived Assets

      FiTech evaluates its long-lived assets for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of an asset or asset group to future undiscounted net cash flows expected to be generated by the asset or asset group. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the fair value of the assets, determined based on discounted cash flows. FiTech did not recognize any impairment loss for long-lived assets in the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 or in the six months ended June 30, 2003.

F-36


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
 
      Capitalized Software Costs

      Capitalized software costs for new software products and additional modules for existing software are expensed as incurred until technological feasibility is established, in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 86, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software to be Sold, Leased or Otherwise Marketed. Technological feasibility is established at the point in which a working model of the product has been completed and completeness of the working model and its consistency with the product design has been confirmed by testing. The capitalized software costs are amortized using the straight-line method over the estimated economic life of the capitalized asset, generally three years, which is greater than the ratio of current gross revenues to anticipated total gross revenues for the product. FiTech records amortization of capitalized internal software costs within cost of revenues in the accompanying statements of operations. FiTech capitalized internal software costs of $1,061,000 and $484,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002, respectively, and $248,000 (unaudited) and $227,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, respectively. Amortization expense of capitalized software costs was $133,000 and $434,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002, respectively, and $214,000 (unaudited) and $255,000 for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

 
      Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

      Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the identifiable net assets of an acquired business. Effective January 1, 2002, FiTech adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets. Prior to adopting SFAS No. 142, goodwill was amortized on a straight-line basis over its estimated economic life of 20 years. As a result of adopting SFAS No. 142, goodwill is no longer amortized, but instead is tested for impairment at the reporting unit level at least annually and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that goodwill might be impaired. Management performed an annual impairment test of its goodwill as of October 2002 and has determined that no impairment charge is necessary.

 
      Revenue Recognition

      FiTech generates revenues from licensing the rights to use its software products and certain third-party software products to end-users. FiTech also generates revenues from customer support and maintenance, installation services, professional and training services provided to customers, data center services and hardware sales. FiTech’s maintenance and support arrangements offer unspecified upgrades and enhancements on software products only on a when-and-if-available basis. FiTech warrants that their products will function substantially in accordance with documentation provided to customers. To date, FiTech has not incurred any significant expenses related to warranty claims.

      FiTech recognizes revenue in accordance with AICPA Statement of Position 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition. FiTech sells software licenses in conjunction with hardware and professional services for installation and maintenance. FiTech also provides data center services in conjunction with hardware and installation services. For arrangements in which licenses or data center services are bundled with other elements such as maintenance and installation services, FiTech does not have vendor-specific objective evidence of the fair value of the undelivered elements of individual contracts. Accordingly, for sales of these arrangements, FiTech recognizes all elements of the contract, except for hardware, ratably over the contract term. The related costs are also recognized ratably over the contract term. Hardware revenue and related costs are recognized upon delivery.

      Deferred revenue is comprised of payments received in advance of the recognition of revenue.

      FiTech recognizes revenue from hardware arrangements in accordance with EITF 99-19, Reporting Revenue Gross as a Principal versus Net as an Agent. For these arrangements, FiTech is primary obligor, has

F-37


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

latitude in establishing pricing, is involved in determining product specifications, and has general credit risk. Accordingly, FiTech recognizes hardware revenue and related costs on a gross basis.

 
      Research and Development Costs

      Research and development costs, which are described as product development costs in the statements of operations, are expensed as incurred.

 
      Income Taxes

      Liberty has elected to be treated for federal and state income tax purposes as an S Corporation under Subchapter S of the Internal Revenue Code and comparable state laws. Historically, FiTech’s results have been consolidated into Liberty for the purposes of filing tax returns. The tax provision of FiTech has been prepared on a separate tax return basis. Under a separate tax return basis, the earnings of FiTech are passed through as taxable income of FiTech’s stockholders for federal and state income tax purposes. Accordingly, no provision for income taxes has been included in the accompanying financial statements.

 
      Concentration of Credit Risk

      Financial instruments that potentially expose FiTech to concentrations of credit risk are limited to accounts receivable. At December 31, 2001, two individual customers each accounted for 30 percent and 22 percent of accounts receivable. At December 31, 2002, two individual customers each accounted for 49 percent and 14 percent of accounts receivable. At June 30, 2003, no customers accounted for greater than 10 percent of accounts receivable. FiTech maintains allowances for potential credit risks and otherwise controls this risk through monitoring procedures.

      In the years ended December 31, 2001 and the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, no customers accounted for greater than the 10 percent of revenues. In the year ended December 31, 2002, two individual customers each accounted for 13 percent and 10 percent of revenues.

 
      Fair Value of Financial Instruments

      The carrying amount of accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued expenses approximate fair value because of the short maturity of those instruments. The carrying amount of notes payable approximates fair value, and a fluctuation in interest rates would not be material to FiTech’s financial position.

 
      Recent Accounting Pronouncements

      In November 2002, the Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) issued EITF Issue No. 00-21, Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables. This issue addresses revenue recognition for arrangements with multiple deliverables which should be considered as separate units of accounting if the deliverables meet certain criteria as described in EITF 00-21. This issue is effective for revenue arrangements entered into in fiscal periods beginning after June 15, 2003. Early adoption is permitted.

      In November 2002, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 45, Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others. FIN No. 45 requires that a liability be recorded in the guarantor’s balance sheet upon issuance of a guarantee. In addition, FIN No. 45 requires disclosure about the guarantees that an entity has issued, including a reconciliation of changes in the entity’s product warranty liabilities. The initial recognition and initial measurement provisions of FIN No. 45 are applicable on a prospective basis to guarantees issued or modified after December 31, 2002. The disclosure requirements of FIN No. 45 are effective for financial statements of annual periods ending after

F-38


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

December 15, 2002. FiTech’s software license agreements do not provide indemnification for any third-party performance.

      In May 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and Equity. SFAS No. 150 changes the accounting for certain financial instruments that, under previous guidance, could be classified as equity or “mezzanine” equity, including mandatorily redeemable instruments, by now requiring those instruments to be classified as liabilities in the statement of financial position. Further, SFAS No. 150 requires disclosure regarding the terms of those instruments and settlement alternatives. For private companies, mandatorily redeemable financial instruments are subject to the provisions of SFAS No. 150 for the fiscal period beginning after December 15, 2003.

      The adoption of these standards does not have any impact on our financial statements.

4.     Acquisition

      In September 2002, FiTech acquired substantially all of the assets of Perform, Inc. (“Perform”), a re-seller of FiTech’s products. FiTech paid a purchase price of $1,000,000 comprised of $850,000 in cash and $150,000 in a note payable. The acquisition was accounted for as a purchase transaction and the operating results of Perform have been included in the financial statements from the date of acquisition. Accordingly, the purchase price was allocated to the assets acquired based on fair value as follows:

         
Tangible assets acquired
  $ 22,000  
Customer list
    953,000  
Covenant not to compete
    25,000  
     
 
    $ 1,000,000  
     
 

      The fair value of the identifiable intangibles was determined based on management’s valuation analysis utilizing an income approach that takes into account future cash flows. The amortizable intangibles are being amortized over a useful life of 5 to 15 years.

5.     Fixed Assets

                         
December 31, December 31, June 30,
2001 2002 2003



Computer hardware
  $ 1,840,000     $ 1,933,000     $ 2,132,000  
Office furniture and equipment
    81,000       81,000       83,000  
Leasehold improvements
    114,000       114,000       114,000  
     
     
     
 
      2,035,000       2,128,000       2,329,000  
Less: accumulated depreciation
    (526,000 )     (1,080,000 )     (1,369,000 )
     
     
     
 
    $ 1,509,000     $ 1,048,000     $ 960,000  
     
     
     
 

      Depreciation and amortization expense on fixed assets was $480,000 and $554,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002, respectively, and $270,000 (unaudited) and $289,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

6.     Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

      The goodwill of $6,843,000, recorded at December 31, 2001 and 2002 and June 30, 2003, was related to the acquisition of FiTech by Liberty in August 2000.

F-39


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      Upon FiTech’s adoption of SFAS 142 as of January 1, 2002, amortization of goodwill ceased. No amortization expense related to goodwill was recognized in 2002, and the statements of operations include amortization expense related to goodwill of $663,000 in 2001, which was included in general and administrative expenses. Net loss for the year ended December 31, 2001, adjusted to exclude amortization expense, would have been $2,315,000. FiTech recorded accumulated amortization expense related to goodwill of $874,000 through December 31, 2001.

      FiTech also has other purchased intangible assets with the following balances at each respective balance sheet date:

                         
December 31, December 31, June 30,
2001 2002 2003



Customer lists
  $ 5,865,000     $ 6,819,000     $ 6,819,000  
Other
    288,000       313,000       313,000  
Less: Accumulated amortization
    (540,000 )     (980,000 )     (1,252,000 )
     
     
     
 
Other intangible assets
  $ 5,613,000     $ 6,152,000     $ 5,880,000  
     
     
     
 

      The purchased intangibles relate to the acquisition of FiTech by Liberty in August 2000 and to the acquisition of Perform by FiTech in September 2002 (Note 4).

      The estimated amortization expense for other intangible assets for each of the next five years is expected to approximate:

         
2003
  $ 497,000  
2004
    455,000  
2005
    455,000  
2006
    455,000  
2007
    455,000  

7.     Accrued Expenses

                         
December 31, December 31, June 30,
2001 2002 2003



Deferred compensation (Note 11)
  $ 290,000     $ 328,000     $ 340,000  
Salary and bonuses
    122,000       224,000       32,000  
Interest
    49,000       71,000       84,000  
Other
    72,000       157,000       141,000  
     
     
     
 
    $ 533,000     $ 780,000     $ 597,000  
     
     
     
 

      In connection with the acquisition of FiTech by Open Solutions (see Note 1), the accruals for deferred compensation, salary and bonuses, and interest were not assumed by Open Solutions.

8.     Long-Term Debt

      In conjunction with the acquisition of FiTech by Liberty in September 2000, FiTech issued a $1,000,000 note payable to MASREM L.P., which is an entity controlled by the President of FiTech. In May 2001, FiTech made a prepayment of $200,000 on the note. In June 2001, the parties reduced the principal balance of the note by an additional $559,000 due to various credits that reduced the purchase price. The note accrues interest at a rate of 9 percent and is due in full on January 2, 2004.

F-40


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      In conjunction with the acquisition of Perform in August 2002 (see Note 4), FiTech entered into a note payable to Perform. The note, which has an original principal balance of $150,000, accrues interest at a rate equal to the prime lending rate and is due in three equal installments on January 1, 2006, January 1, 2007 and January 1, 2008. The payment of the note is subject to a condition that revenue from customers acquired from Perform reaches certain thresholds in the second and third year after purchase. Management expects that revenue from these acquired customers will meet the thresholds and, accordingly, the full amount has been accrued.

      Long-term debt, excluding the Advances from Liberty (see Note 2), is comprised of the following:

                         
December 31, December 31, June 30,
2001 2002 2003



Note payable to MASREM L.P. 
  $ 241,000     $ 241,000     $ 241,000  
Note payable to Perform, Inc. 
          150,000       150,000  
     
     
     
 
      241,000       391,000       391,000  
Less: current maturities
                (241,000 )
     
     
     
 
    $ 241,000     $ 391,000     $ 150,000  
     
     
     
 

      The future principal maturities of long-term debt, excluding Advances from Liberty, are approximately as follows as of June 30, 2003:

         
Year Ended December 31,
2004
  $ 241,000  
2005
     
2006
    50,000  
2007
    50,000  
2008
    50,000  

9.     Capital Lease Obligations

      In April 2001, FiTech entered into a capital lease agreement for computer equipment. The capital lease is payable in monthly installments through March 2005 and has an incremental borrowing rate of 7.5 percent. In April 2003, FiTech entered into an additional capital lease agreement for computer equipment. This capital lease is payable in monthly installments through March 2005 and has an incremental borrowing rate of 5.5 percent. Both capital lease obligations are collateralized by the equipment under these leases.

      Capital lease obligations are comprised of the following:

                         
December 31, December 31, June 30,
2001 2002 2003



Computer equipment lease
  $ 1,035,000     $ 695,000     $ 667,000  
Less: current maturities
    (340,000 )     (331,000 )     (408,000 )
     
     
     
 
    $ 695,000     $ 364,000     $ 259,000  
     
     
     
 

F-41


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

      Future minimum payments under these leases are as follows:

           
Six Months Ended December 31, 2003
  $ 195,000  
Year Ended December 31,
       
 
2004
    468,000  
 
2005
    117,000  
     
 
Total minimum lease payments
    780,000  
Amounts representing interest
    (113,000 )
     
 
Present value of minimum lease payments
  $ 667,000  
     
 

      The capitalized cost and accumulated amortization of assets acquired under capital leases included in the amounts presented above, are summarized as follows:

                         
December 31, December 31, June 30,
2001 2002 2003



Computer equipment
  $ 1,287,000     $ 1,287,000     $ 1,456,000  
Accumulated amortization
    (241,000 )     (563,000 )     (745,000 )
     
     
     
 
    $ 1,046,000     $ 724,000     $ 711,000  
     
     
     
 

      Amortization expense for property and equipment under capital leases amounted to approximately $241,000 and $322,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002, respectively, and $161,000 (unaudited) and $182,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

10.     401(k) Plan

      Employees of FiTech are eligible to contribute to a voluntary 401(k) plan sponsored by Liberty. Liberty provides matching contributions of 100 percent of the first 8% of the employee’s compensation that is deferred under the plan. Expense recognized for the Liberty contributions to the accounts of FiTech employees for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 and the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003 were $409,000, $454,000, $227,000 (unaudited) and $303,000, respectively.

11.     Commitments and Contingencies

      At June 30, 2003, FiTech was committed under facility and various other operating leases, which expire at various dates through 2006. Minimum future lease payments under noncancelable leases with a remaining term of greater than one year at December 31, 2003 are approximately as follows:

           
Six Months Ended December 31, 2003
  $ 261,000  
Years Ended December 31,
       
 
2004
    316,000  
 
2005
    24,000  
     
 
Total minimum obligations
  $ 601,000  
     
 

      Rent expense under operating leases was $420,000, $399,000, $185,000 (unaudited) and $244,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 and the six months ended June 30, 2002 and 2003, respectively.

      In September 2000, FiTech entered into a deferred compensation arrangement with an employee which provides the individual with a payment of the sum of a) $250,000, b) a quarterly benefit of $6,000, and

F-42


Table of Contents

LIBERTY FITECH SYSTEMS, INC.
(a wholly-owned subsidiary of Liberty Enterprises, Inc.)
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)

c) an additional $25,000 for each fiscal year that FiTech achieves its performance goals and the individual’s employment continues. The payment will be made on the earlier of January 1, 2004, or thirty days after termination of the employee. The payment will be made in installments on the first, second and third anniversary dates of the employment termination, and the unpaid amount will accrued 8 percent interest from the commencing on the date of termination. FiTech recorded an accrual of $290,000, $328,000 and $340,000 as of December 31, 2001 and 2002 and June 30, 2003, respectively, related to this deferred compensation arrangement.

F-43


Table of Contents



         No dealer, salesperson or other person is authorized to give any information or to represent anything not contained in this prospectus. You must not rely on any unauthorized information or representations. This prospectus is an offer to sell only the shares offered hereby, but only under circumstance and in jurisdictions where it is lawful to do so. The information contained in this prospectus is current only as of its date.


TABLE OF CONTENTS

         
Page

About This Prospectus
    i  
Prospectus Summary
    1  
Risk Factors
    7  
Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
    18  
Use Of Proceeds
    19  
Price Range of Common Stock
    20  
Dividend Policy
    20  
Capitalization
    21  
Dilution
    22  
Selected Consolidated Financial Data
    23  
Management’s Discussion And Analysis Of Financial Condition And Results Of Operations
    25  
Business
    38  
Management
    52  
Related Party Transactions
    61  
Principal and Selling Stockholders
    65  
Description Of Capital Stock
    68  
Shares Eligible For Future Sale
    72  
Material U.S. Federal Tax Considerations For Non-U.S. Holders Of Our Common Stock
    75  
Underwriting
    78  
Legal Matters
    81  
Experts
    81  
Where You Can Find More Information
    81  
Unaudited Pro Forma Combined Condensed Financial Statements
    P-1  
Index To Financial Statements
    F-1  





4,339,384 shares

(Open Solutions Logo)

Common Stock


PROSPECTUS


                        , 2004

Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc.

Friedman Billings Ramsey

Piper Jaffray

Wachovia Securities




Table of Contents

PART II

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 13.     Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

      The following table sets forth the estimated expenses payable by us in connection with the offering (excluding underwriting discounts and commissions):

           
Nature of Expense Amount


SEC Registration Fee
  $ 13,936  
NASD Filing Fee
    12,000  
Accounting Fees and Expenses
    115,000  
Legal Fees and Expenses
    180,000  
Printing Expenses
    150,000  
Blue Sky Qualification Fees and Expenses
    10,000  
Miscellaneous
    19,064  
     
 
 
Total
    500,000  
     
 

      The amounts set forth above, except for the Securities and Exchange Commission and National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. fees, are in each case estimated.

Item 14.     Indemnification of Directors and Officers

      Article SEVENTH of our Restated Certificate of Incorporation, as amended to date (the “Charter”) eliminates the personal liability of directors to the fullest extent permitted by Section 102(b)(7) of the Delaware General Corporation Law and provides that no director of our company shall be personally liable for any monetary damages for any breach of fiduciary duty as a director, except to the extent that the Delaware General Corporation Law statute prohibits the elimination or limitation of liability of directors for breach of fiduciary duty.

      Article EIGHTH of our Charter provides that each of our directors and officers (a) shall be indemnified by us against all expenses (including attorneys’ fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement incurred in connection with any litigation or other legal proceeding (other than an action by or in the right of us) threatened or brought against him by virtue of the fact that he is, or has agreed to serve as, a director or officer of our company or is serving in the position of director, officer, partner, employee or trustee of another corporation, partnership, joint venture trust or other enterprise on our behalf, if he acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed to, our best interests, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, he had no reasonable cause to believe his conduct was unlawful and (b) shall be indemnified by us against all expenses (including attorneys’ fees) and amounts paid in settlement incurred in connection with any action by or in the right of us brought against him by virtue of the fact that he is, or has agreed to serve as, a director or officer of our company or is serving in the position of director, officer, partner, employee or trustee of another corporation, partnership, joint venture trust or other enterprise on our behalf, if he acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed to, our best interests, except that no indemnification shall be made with respect to any matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be liable to us, unless a court determines that, despite such adjudication but in view of all of the circumstances, he is entitled to indemnification of such expenses. Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent that a director or officer has been successful, on the merits or otherwise, including, without limitation, the dismissal of an action without prejudice, he is required to be indemnified by us against all expenses (including attorneys’ fees) incurred in connection therewith. Expenses shall be advanced to a director or officer at his request, provided that he undertakes to repay the amount advanced if it is ultimately determined that he is not entitled to indemnification for such expenses.

II-1


Table of Contents

      Indemnification is required to be made unless we determine that the applicable standard of conduct required for indemnification has not been met. In the event of a determination by us that the director or officer did not meet the applicable standard of conduct required for indemnification or if we fail to make an indemnification payment within 30 days after such payment is claimed by such person, such person is permitted to petition the court to make an independent determination as to whether such person is entitled to indemnification. As a condition precedent to the right of indemnification, the director or officer must give us notice of the action for which indemnity is sought and we have the right to participate in such action or assume the defense thereof.

      Article EIGHTH of our Charter further provides that the indemnification provided therein is not exclusive, and provides that in the event that the Delaware General Corporation Law statute is amended, we must continue to indemnify our directors and officers with respect to any action that arose prior to the amendment, to the same extent that the director or officer would have been indemnified prior to the amendment.

      Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that a corporation has the power to indemnify a director, officer, employee, or agent of the corporation and certain other persons serving at the request of the corporation in related capacities against amounts paid and expenses incurred in connection with an action or proceeding to which he is or is threatened to be made a party by reason of such position, if such person shall have acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, in any criminal proceeding, if such person has no reasonable cause to believe his conduct was unlawful, except that, in the case of actions brought by or in the right of the corporation, no indemnification shall be made with respect to any matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be liable to the corporation unless and only to the extent that the adjudicating court determines that such indemnification is proper under the circumstances.

      We maintain a general liability insurance policy which covers certain liabilities of directors and officers of our corporation arising out of claims based on acts or omissions in their capacities as directors or officers.

      In any underwriting agreement we enter into in connection with the sale of common stock being registered hereby, the underwriters will agree to indemnify, under certain conditions, us, our directors, our officers and persons who control us within the meaning of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), against certain liabilities.

      At present, there is no pending litigation or proceeding involving any director, officer, employee or agent as to which indemnification will be required or permitted under our Charter. The Registrant is not aware of any threatened litigation or proceeding that may result in a claim for such indemnification.

Item 15.     Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

      Set forth below is information regarding shares of common stock and preferred stock issued, and options and restricted stock awards granted, by the Registrant within the past three years. Also included is the consideration, if any, received by the Registrant for such shares, and information relating to the section of the Securities Act, or rule of the Securities and Exchange Commission under which exemption from registration was claimed. Certain of the transactions described below involved directors, officers and five percent stockholders of the Registrant. See “Related Party Transactions.”

(a) Issuance of Capital Stock

      1.     On August 3, 2001, the Registrant issued a total of 80,472 shares of Series G preferred stock and 55,496 shares of common stock to four stockholders of Sound Software Development, Inc. (“Sound Software”) in connection with the merger of Sound Software into a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Registrant.

      2.     On October 15, 2001, the Registrant issued 83,333 shares of Series C preferred stock to Aetna Life Insurance Company upon the exercise of a warrant.

II-2


Table of Contents

      3.     On November 15, 2001, the Registrant issued 13,889 shares of Series C preferred stock to Connecticut Innovations, Incorporated upon the exercise of a warrant.

      4.     On December 14, 2001, the Registrant issued 314,486 shares of common stock to four stockholders of Imagic Corporation (“Imagic”) in connection with the merger of Imagic into a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Registrant.

      5.     On July 1, 2003, the Registrant issued 133,195 shares of common stock to Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. in connection with the acquisition of substantially all of the assets of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. by a subsidiary of the Registrant. Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. was an accredited investor.

      No underwriters were involved in the foregoing sales of securities. The securities described in this paragraph (a) of Item 15 were issued to these individuals and entities in reliance upon exemptions from the registration provisions of the Securities Act set forth in Section 4(2) thereof relative to sales by an issuer not involving any public offering, to the extent an exemption from such registration was required. With the exception of the four stockholders of Imagic referenced in number 7, all purchasers of shares of our preferred stock described above represented to us in connection with their purchase that they were accredited investors and were acquiring the shares for investment and not distribution, that they could bear the risks of the investment and could hold the securities for an indefinite period of time. The purchasers received written disclosures that the securities had not been registered under the Securities Act and that any resale must be made pursuant to a registration or an available exemption from registration.

(b) Stock Option and Restricted Stock Grants

      1.     From March 31, 2001 to February 6, 2004, the date of the filing of the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-8, the Registrant issued an aggregate of 137,815 shares of common stock to 37 individuals pursuant to the exercise of stock options.

      2.     On May 7, 2003, the Registrant issued an aggregate of 680,530 shares of common stock to nineteen employees pursuant to the Registrant’s 2000 Stock Incentive Plan. Each of the nineteen employees executed a Stock Restriction Agreement that placed restrictions on the shares of common stock that were issued, which restrictions lapsed upon the completion of the Registrant’s initial public offering.

      3.     The Registrant’s 1994 Stock Option Plan was adopted by the board of directors and approved by the stockholders of the Registrant in March 1994. As of March 31, 2004, options to purchase 928,818 shares of common stock had been exercised for an aggregate consideration of $1,017,670, and options to purchase 1,130,011 shares of common stock, at a weighted average price of $5.502 per share, were outstanding under the plan. On February 6, 2004 the Registrant filed a Form S-8 registering 1,363,733 shares issuable under the 1994 Stock Option Plan.

      4.     The Registrant’s 2000 Stock Incentive Plan was adopted by the board of directors and approved by the stockholders of the Registrant in December 2000. As of March 31, 2004, options to purchase 30,101 shares of common stock had been exercised for an aggregate consideration of $218,232, and options to purchase 2,118,067 shares of common stock, at a weighted average price of $10.4696 per share, were outstanding under the plan. On February 6, 2004, the Registrant filed a Form S-8 registering 3,948,593 shares issuable under the 2000 Stock Incentive Plan.

      5.     The Registrant’s 2003 Stock Incentive Plan was adopted by the board of directors in August 2003 and approved by the stockholders of the Registrant in October 2003. No options or other awards have been granted or issued under the plan. On February 6, 2004, the Registrant filed a Form S-8 registering 2,068,965 shares issuable under the 2003 Stock Incentive Plan.

      6.     The Registrant’s 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan was adopted by the board of directors in August 2003 and approved by the stockholders of the Registrant in October 2003. The first offering period under the 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan commenced on January 1, 2004, and as of April 21, 2004, no shares have been issued under the plan. On December 23, 2003, the Registrant filed a Form S-8 registering 1,379,310 shares issuable under the 2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan.

II-3


Table of Contents

      The issuance of stock options and the common stock issuable upon the exercise of stock options as described in this paragraph (b) of Item 15 were issued pursuant to written compensatory plans or arrangements with the Registrant’s employees, directors and consultants, in reliance on the exemption provided by Rule 701 promulgated under the Securities Act, as well as Section 4(2) of the Securities Act (to the extent not registered on Form S-8). All recipients either received adequate information about us or had access, through employment or other relationships, to such information.

Item 16.     Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

      See the Exhibit Index on the page immediately preceding the exhibits for a list of exhibits filed as part of this registration statement on Form S-1, which Exhibit Index is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 17.     Undertakings

      The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the Underwriting Agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.

      Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

      The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:

        (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.
 
        (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

II-4


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

      Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the city of Glastonbury, state of Connecticut, on April 21, 2004.

  OPEN SOLUTIONS INC.

  By:  /s/ LOUIS HERNANDEZ, JR.
 
  Louis Hernandez, Jr.
  Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

POWER OF ATTORNEY AND SIGNATURES

      KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS that each individual whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints each of Louis Hernandez, Jr. and Carl D. Blandino such person’s true and lawful attorney-in-fact and agent with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for such person and in such person’s name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments (other than post-effective amendments) to this Registration Statement (or to any other registration statement for the same offering that is to be effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act), and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and all documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto each said attorney-in-fact and agent full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in and about the premises, as fully to all intents and purposes as such person might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that any said attorney-in-fact and agent, or any substitute or substitutes of any of them, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

      Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

             
Signature Title Date



 
/s/ LOUIS HERNANDEZ, JR.

Louis Hernandez, Jr.
  Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)   April 21, 2004
 
/s/ CARL D. BLANDINO

Carl D. Blandino
  Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary (Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)   April 21, 2004
 
/s/ DOUGLAS K. ANDERSON

Douglas K. Anderson
  Director   April 21, 2004
 
/s/ DOUGLAS C. CARLISLE

Douglas C. Carlisle
  Director   April 21, 2004
 
/s/ DAVID DAME

David Dame
  Director   April 21, 2004
 
/s/ SAMUEL F. MCKAY

Samuel F. McKay
  Director   April 21, 2004
 
/s/ CARLOS P. NAUDON

Carlos P. Naudon
  Director   April 21, 2004
 


Richard P. Yanak
  Director    

II-5


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

             
Exhibit
Number Description


  *1 .1       Form of Underwriting Agreement.
  2 .1       Asset Purchase Agreement between Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc., Liberty Enterprises, Inc., Open Solutions FiTech, Inc. and Open Solutions Inc. dated June 30, 2003, together with Promissory Note made by Open Solutions FiTech, Inc. in favor of Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. for the principal sum of $1,700,000 dated June 30, 2003, together with Security Agreement between Open Solutions FiTech, Inc. and Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. dated June 30, 2003 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 28, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  2 .2       Agreement and Plan of Merger and Reorganization between Open Solutions Inc., OSI Merger Corporation, Imagic Corporation and the stockholders listed therein dated December 14, 2001 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 28, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  2 .3       Stock Purchase Agreement among Open Solutions Inc., OSI Acquisition Sub, Inc., Maxxar Corporation and the Stockholders listed on Schedule 1 thereto, dated as of February 24, 2004 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 24, 2004 (File No. 0-02333)).
  3 .1       Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Registrant (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 3 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 7, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  3 .2       Amended and Restated By-Laws of the Registrant (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 3 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 7, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  4 .1       Specimen certificate for shares of the Registrant’s Common Stock (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 3 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 7, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  *5 .1       Opinion of Hale and Dorr LLP, counsel to the Registrant, regarding the legality of the shares of common stock.
  10 .1       1994 Stock Option Plan, as amended (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 1 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 7, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .2       2000 Stock Incentive Plan, as amended (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 1 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 7, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .3       2003 Stock Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 1 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 7, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .4       2003 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, as amended (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 6 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 24, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .5       Amended and Restated Investors’ Rights Agreement between Open Solutions Inc. and the Investors (as defined therein) dated March 17, 2000 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 28, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .6       Employment Agreement between Open Solutions Inc. and Louis Hernandez, Jr. dated May 6, 2002 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 28, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).

II-6


Table of Contents

             
Exhibit
Number Description


  +10 .7       Software License Agreement between Open Solutions Inc. and BISYS, Inc. dated as of September 1, 2003 (Incorporated by reference to Amendment No. 5 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 21, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .8       Gross Lease between Open Solutions Inc. and Principal Mutual Life Insurance Company dated February 29, 1996, as amended by the First Amendment to Lease between Open Solutions Inc. and Principal Mutual Life Insurance Company dated January 27, 1998, as amended by the Second Amendment to Lease between Open Solutions Inc. and Principal Life Insurance Company (f/k/a Principal Mutual Life Insurance Company) dated May 25, 1999, as amended by the Third Amendment to Lease between Open Solutions Inc. and Foster Properties, LLC (as successor-in-interest to Principal Life Insurance Company) dated September 16, 1999, as amended by the Fourth Amendment to Lease between Open Solutions Inc. and Foster Properties, LLC dated November 29, 2000 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 28, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .9       Lease between Open Solutions Inc. and Carl Foster, LLC dated February 14, 2000, as amended by the Amendment of Lease between Open Solutions Inc. and Carl Foster, LLC dated May 8, 2000 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 28, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  10 .10       Lease Agreement between FiTech Systems, Inc. and Piedmont/ Maple, L.L.C. dated January 22, 1998, as amended by the First Amendment to Lease Agreement between FiTech Systems, Inc. and Piedmont/ Maple, L.L.C. dated February 10, 1999, as amended by the Second Amendment to Lease Agreement between FiTech Systems, L.P. and Piedmont/ Maple, L.L.C. dated September 3, 1999, as amended by the Assignment of Lease between FiTech Systems, L.P. (as assignor) and Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. (as assignee) dated August 31, 2000, as amended by the Third Amendment to Lease Agreement between Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. and Piedmont/ Maple, L.L.C. dated May 29, 2001, as amended by the Fourth Amendment to Lease Agreement between Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. and Piedmont/ Maple, L.L.C. dated January 21, 2002, as amended by the Assignment and Assumption of Lease Agreement between Liberty FiTech Systems, Inc. (as assignor), Open Solutions FiTech, Inc. (as assignee) and Piedmont/ Maple, L.L.C. dated June 30, 2003 (Incorporated by reference to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 28, 2003 (File No. 333-108293)).
  21 .1       List of Subsidiaries of Open Solutions Inc.
  23 .1       Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
  *23 .2       Consent of Hale and Dorr LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).
  24 .1       Power of Attorney (included on page II-5).


To be filed by amendment.
 
Confidential treatment granted as to certain portions of this Exhibit pursuant to Rule 406 promulgated under the Securities Act. Such portions have been omitted and filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

II-7